LLVM Language Reference Manual¶
- Abstract
- Introduction
- Identifiers
- High Level Structure
- Module Structure
- Linkage Types
- Calling Conventions
- Visibility Styles
- DLL Storage Classes
- Thread Local Storage Models
- Structure Types
- Global Variables
- Functions
- Aliases
- Comdats
- Named Metadata
- Parameter Attributes
- Garbage Collector Strategy Names
- Prefix Data
- Prologue Data
- Personality Function
- Attribute Groups
- Function Attributes
- Operand Bundles
- Module-Level Inline Assembly
- Data Layout
- Target Triple
- Pointer Aliasing Rules
- Volatile Memory Accesses
- Memory Model for Concurrent Operations
- Atomic Memory Ordering Constraints
- Fast-Math Flags
- Use-list Order Directives
- Type System
- Constants
- Other Values
- Metadata
- Metadata Nodes and Metadata Strings
- Specialized Metadata Nodes
- DICompileUnit
- DIFile
- DIBasicType
- DISubroutineType
- DIDerivedType
- DICompositeType
- DISubrange
- DIEnumerator
- DITemplateTypeParameter
- DITemplateValueParameter
- DINamespace
- DIGlobalVariable
- DISubprogram
- DILexicalBlock
- DILexicalBlockFile
- DILocation
- DILocalVariable
- DIExpression
- DIObjCProperty
- DIImportedEntity
- DIMacro
- DIMacroFile
- ‘
tbaa
‘ Metadata - ‘
tbaa.struct
‘ Metadata - ‘
noalias
‘ and ‘alias.scope
‘ Metadata - ‘
fpmath
‘ Metadata - ‘
range
‘ Metadata - ‘
unpredictable
‘ Metadata - ‘
llvm.loop
‘ - ‘
llvm.loop.vectorize
‘ and ‘llvm.loop.interleave
‘ - ‘
llvm.loop.interleave.count
‘ Metadata - ‘
llvm.loop.vectorize.enable
‘ Metadata - ‘
llvm.loop.vectorize.width
‘ Metadata - ‘
llvm.loop.unroll
‘ - ‘
llvm.loop.unroll.count
‘ Metadata - ‘
llvm.loop.unroll.disable
‘ Metadata - ‘
llvm.loop.unroll.runtime.disable
‘ Metadata - ‘
llvm.loop.unroll.enable
‘ Metadata - ‘
llvm.loop.unroll.full
‘ Metadata - ‘
llvm.loop.licm_versioning.disable
‘ Metadata - ‘
llvm.mem
‘ - ‘
llvm.mem.parallel_loop_access
‘ Metadata - ‘
llvm.bitsets
‘ - ‘
invariant.group
‘ Metadata
- Specialized Metadata Nodes
- Metadata Nodes and Metadata Strings
- Module Flags Metadata
- Intrinsic Global Variables
- Instruction Reference
- Terminator Instructions
- Binary Operations
- Bitwise Binary Operations
- Vector Operations
- Aggregate Operations
- Memory Access and Addressing Operations
- Conversion Operations
- ‘
trunc .. to
‘ Instruction - ‘
zext .. to
‘ Instruction - ‘
sext .. to
‘ Instruction - ‘
fptrunc .. to
‘ Instruction - ‘
fpext .. to
‘ Instruction - ‘
fptoui .. to
‘ Instruction - ‘
fptosi .. to
‘ Instruction - ‘
uitofp .. to
‘ Instruction - ‘
sitofp .. to
‘ Instruction - ‘
ptrtoint .. to
‘ Instruction - ‘
inttoptr .. to
‘ Instruction - ‘
bitcast .. to
‘ Instruction - ‘
addrspacecast .. to
‘ Instruction
- ‘
- Other Operations
- Intrinsic Functions
- Variable Argument Handling Intrinsics
- Accurate Garbage Collection Intrinsics
- Code Generator Intrinsics
- ‘
llvm.returnaddress
‘ Intrinsic - ‘
llvm.frameaddress
‘ Intrinsic - ‘
llvm.localescape
‘ and ‘llvm.localrecover
‘ Intrinsics - ‘
llvm.read_register
‘ and ‘llvm.write_register
‘ Intrinsics - ‘
llvm.stacksave
‘ Intrinsic - ‘
llvm.stackrestore
‘ Intrinsic - ‘
llvm.get.dynamic.area.offset
‘ Intrinsic - ‘
llvm.prefetch
‘ Intrinsic - ‘
llvm.pcmarker
‘ Intrinsic - ‘
llvm.readcyclecounter
‘ Intrinsic - ‘
llvm.clear_cache
‘ Intrinsic - ‘
llvm.instrprof_increment
‘ Intrinsic - ‘
llvm.instrprof_value_profile
‘ Intrinsic
- ‘
- Standard C Library Intrinsics
- ‘
llvm.memcpy
‘ Intrinsic - ‘
llvm.memmove
‘ Intrinsic - ‘
llvm.memset.*
‘ Intrinsics - ‘
llvm.sqrt.*
‘ Intrinsic - ‘
llvm.powi.*
‘ Intrinsic - ‘
llvm.sin.*
‘ Intrinsic - ‘
llvm.cos.*
‘ Intrinsic - ‘
llvm.pow.*
‘ Intrinsic - ‘
llvm.exp.*
‘ Intrinsic - ‘
llvm.exp2.*
‘ Intrinsic - ‘
llvm.log.*
‘ Intrinsic - ‘
llvm.log10.*
‘ Intrinsic - ‘
llvm.log2.*
‘ Intrinsic - ‘
llvm.fma.*
‘ Intrinsic - ‘
llvm.fabs.*
‘ Intrinsic - ‘
llvm.minnum.*
‘ Intrinsic - ‘
llvm.maxnum.*
‘ Intrinsic - ‘
llvm.copysign.*
‘ Intrinsic - ‘
llvm.floor.*
‘ Intrinsic - ‘
llvm.ceil.*
‘ Intrinsic - ‘
llvm.trunc.*
‘ Intrinsic - ‘
llvm.rint.*
‘ Intrinsic - ‘
llvm.nearbyint.*
‘ Intrinsic - ‘
llvm.round.*
‘ Intrinsic
- ‘
- Bit Manipulation Intrinsics
- Arithmetic with Overflow Intrinsics
- Specialised Arithmetic Intrinsics
- Half Precision Floating Point Intrinsics
- Debugger Intrinsics
- Exception Handling Intrinsics
- Trampoline Intrinsics
- Masked Vector Load and Store Intrinsics
- Masked Vector Gather and Scatter Intrinsics
- Memory Use Markers
- General Intrinsics
- ‘
llvm.var.annotation
‘ Intrinsic - ‘
llvm.ptr.annotation.*
‘ Intrinsic - ‘
llvm.annotation.*
‘ Intrinsic - ‘
llvm.trap
‘ Intrinsic - ‘
llvm.debugtrap
‘ Intrinsic - ‘
llvm.stackprotector
‘ Intrinsic - ‘
llvm.stackprotectorcheck
‘ Intrinsic - ‘
llvm.objectsize
‘ Intrinsic - ‘
llvm.expect
‘ Intrinsic - ‘
llvm.assume
‘ Intrinsic - ‘
llvm.bitset.test
‘ Intrinsic - ‘
llvm.donothing
‘ Intrinsic - ‘
llvm.experimental.deoptimize
‘ Intrinsic - ‘
llvm.experimental.guard
‘ Intrinsic
- ‘
- Stack Map Intrinsics
Abstract¶
This document is a reference manual for the LLVM assembly language. LLVM is a Static Single Assignment (SSA) based representation that provides type safety, low-level operations, flexibility, and the capability of representing ‘all’ high-level languages cleanly. It is the common code representation used throughout all phases of the LLVM compilation strategy.
Introduction¶
The LLVM code representation is designed to be used in three different forms: as an in-memory compiler IR, as an on-disk bitcode representation (suitable for fast loading by a Just-In-Time compiler), and as a human readable assembly language representation. This allows LLVM to provide a powerful intermediate representation for efficient compiler transformations and analysis, while providing a natural means to debug and visualize the transformations. The three different forms of LLVM are all equivalent. This document describes the human readable representation and notation.
The LLVM representation aims to be light-weight and low-level while being expressive, typed, and extensible at the same time. It aims to be a “universal IR” of sorts, by being at a low enough level that high-level ideas may be cleanly mapped to it (similar to how microprocessors are “universal IR’s”, allowing many source languages to be mapped to them). By providing type information, LLVM can be used as the target of optimizations: for example, through pointer analysis, it can be proven that a C automatic variable is never accessed outside of the current function, allowing it to be promoted to a simple SSA value instead of a memory location.
Well-Formedness¶
It is important to note that this document describes ‘well formed’ LLVM assembly language. There is a difference between what the parser accepts and what is considered ‘well formed’. For example, the following instruction is syntactically okay, but not well formed:
%x = add i32 1, %x
because the definition of %x
does not dominate all of its uses. The
LLVM infrastructure provides a verification pass that may be used to
verify that an LLVM module is well formed. This pass is automatically
run by the parser after parsing input assembly and by the optimizer
before it outputs bitcode. The violations pointed out by the verifier
pass indicate bugs in transformation passes or input to the parser.
Identifiers¶
LLVM identifiers come in two basic types: global and local. Global
identifiers (functions, global variables) begin with the '@'
character. Local identifiers (register names, types) begin with the
'%'
character. Additionally, there are three different formats for
identifiers, for different purposes:
- Named values are represented as a string of characters with their
prefix. For example,
%foo
,@DivisionByZero
,%a.really.long.identifier
. The actual regular expression used is ‘[%@][-a-zA-Z$._][-a-zA-Z$._0-9]*
‘. Identifiers that require other characters in their names can be surrounded with quotes. Special characters may be escaped using"\xx"
wherexx
is the ASCII code for the character in hexadecimal. In this way, any character can be used in a name value, even quotes themselves. The"\01"
prefix can be used on global variables to suppress mangling. - Unnamed values are represented as an unsigned numeric value with
their prefix. For example,
%12
,@2
,%44
. - Constants, which are described in the section Constants below.
LLVM requires that values start with a prefix for two reasons: Compilers don’t need to worry about name clashes with reserved words, and the set of reserved words may be expanded in the future without penalty. Additionally, unnamed identifiers allow a compiler to quickly come up with a temporary variable without having to avoid symbol table conflicts.
Reserved words in LLVM are very similar to reserved words in other
languages. There are keywords for different opcodes (‘add
‘,
‘bitcast
‘, ‘ret
‘, etc...), for primitive type names (‘void
‘,
‘i32
‘, etc...), and others. These reserved words cannot conflict
with variable names, because none of them start with a prefix character
('%'
or '@'
).
Here is an example of LLVM code to multiply the integer variable
‘%X
‘ by 8:
The easy way:
%result = mul i32 %X, 8
After strength reduction:
%result = shl i32 %X, 3
And the hard way:
%0 = add i32 %X, %X ; yields i32:%0
%1 = add i32 %0, %0 ; yields i32:%1
%result = add i32 %1, %1
This last way of multiplying %X
by 8 illustrates several important
lexical features of LLVM:
- Comments are delimited with a ‘
;
‘ and go until the end of line. - Unnamed temporaries are created when the result of a computation is not assigned to a named value.
- Unnamed temporaries are numbered sequentially (using a per-function incrementing counter, starting with 0). Note that basic blocks and unnamed function parameters are included in this numbering. For example, if the entry basic block is not given a label name and all function parameters are named, then it will get number 0.
It also shows a convention that we follow in this document. When demonstrating instructions, we will follow an instruction with a comment that defines the type and name of value produced.
High Level Structure¶
Module Structure¶
LLVM programs are composed of Module
‘s, each of which is a
translation unit of the input programs. Each module consists of
functions, global variables, and symbol table entries. Modules may be
combined together with the LLVM linker, which merges function (and
global variable) definitions, resolves forward declarations, and merges
symbol table entries. Here is an example of the “hello world” module:
; Declare the string constant as a global constant.
@.str = private unnamed_addr constant [13 x i8] c"hello world\0A\00"
; External declaration of the puts function
declare i32 @puts(i8* nocapture) nounwind
; Definition of main function
define i32 @main() { ; i32()*
; Convert [13 x i8]* to i8 *...
%cast210 = getelementptr [13 x i8], [13 x i8]* @.str, i64 0, i64 0
; Call puts function to write out the string to stdout.
call i32 @puts(i8* %cast210)
ret i32 0
}
; Named metadata
!0 = !{i32 42, null, !"string"}
!foo = !{!0}
This example is made up of a global variable named
“.str
”, an external declaration of the “puts
” function, a
function definition for “main
” and
named metadata “foo
”.
In general, a module is made up of a list of global values (where both functions and global variables are global values). Global values are represented by a pointer to a memory location (in this case, a pointer to an array of char, and a pointer to a function), and have one of the following linkage types.
Linkage Types¶
All Global Variables and Functions have one of the following types of linkage:
private
- Global values with “
private
” linkage are only directly accessible by objects in the current module. In particular, linking code into a module with an private global value may cause the private to be renamed as necessary to avoid collisions. Because the symbol is private to the module, all references can be updated. This doesn’t show up in any symbol table in the object file. internal
- Similar to private, but the value shows as a local symbol
(
STB_LOCAL
in the case of ELF) in the object file. This corresponds to the notion of the ‘static
‘ keyword in C. available_externally
- Globals with “
available_externally
” linkage are never emitted into the object file corresponding to the LLVM module. From the linker’s perspective, anavailable_externally
global is equivalent to an external declaration. They exist to allow inlining and other optimizations to take place given knowledge of the definition of the global, which is known to be somewhere outside the module. Globals withavailable_externally
linkage are allowed to be discarded at will, and allow inlining and other optimizations. This linkage type is only allowed on definitions, not declarations. linkonce
- Globals with “
linkonce
” linkage are merged with other globals of the same name when linkage occurs. This can be used to implement some forms of inline functions, templates, or other code which must be generated in each translation unit that uses it, but where the body may be overridden with a more definitive definition later. Unreferencedlinkonce
globals are allowed to be discarded. Note thatlinkonce
linkage does not actually allow the optimizer to inline the body of this function into callers because it doesn’t know if this definition of the function is the definitive definition within the program or whether it will be overridden by a stronger definition. To enable inlining and other optimizations, use “linkonce_odr
” linkage. weak
- “
weak
” linkage has the same merging semantics aslinkonce
linkage, except that unreferenced globals withweak
linkage may not be discarded. This is used for globals that are declared “weak” in C source code. common
- “
common
” linkage is most similar to “weak
” linkage, but they are used for tentative definitions in C, such as “int X;
” at global scope. Symbols with “common
” linkage are merged in the same way asweak symbols
, and they may not be deleted if unreferenced.common
symbols may not have an explicit section, must have a zero initializer, and may not be marked ‘constant‘. Functions and aliases may not have common linkage.
appending
- “
appending
” linkage may only be applied to global variables of pointer to array type. When two global variables with appending linkage are linked together, the two global arrays are appended together. This is the LLVM, typesafe, equivalent of having the system linker append together “sections” with identical names when .o files are linked. extern_weak
- The semantics of this linkage follow the ELF object file model: the symbol is weak until linked, if not linked, the symbol becomes null instead of being an undefined reference.
linkonce_odr
,weak_odr
- Some languages allow differing globals to be merged, such as two
functions with different semantics. Other languages, such as
C++
, ensure that only equivalent globals are ever merged (the “one definition rule” — “ODR”). Such languages can use thelinkonce_odr
andweak_odr
linkage types to indicate that the global will only be merged with equivalent globals. These linkage types are otherwise the same as their non-odr
versions. external
- If none of the above identifiers are used, the global is externally visible, meaning that it participates in linkage and can be used to resolve external symbol references.
It is illegal for a function declaration to have any linkage type
other than external
or extern_weak
.
Calling Conventions¶
LLVM functions, calls and invokes can all have an optional calling convention specified for the call. The calling convention of any pair of dynamic caller/callee must match, or the behavior of the program is undefined. The following calling conventions are supported by LLVM, and more may be added in the future:
- “
ccc
” - The C calling convention - This calling convention (the default if no other calling convention is specified) matches the target C calling conventions. This calling convention supports varargs function calls and tolerates some mismatch in the declared prototype and implemented declaration of the function (as does normal C).
- “
fastcc
” - The fast calling convention - This calling convention attempts to make calls as fast as possible (e.g. by passing things in registers). This calling convention allows the target to use whatever tricks it wants to produce fast code for the target, without having to conform to an externally specified ABI (Application Binary Interface). Tail calls can only be optimized when this, the GHC or the HiPE convention is used. This calling convention does not support varargs and requires the prototype of all callees to exactly match the prototype of the function definition.
- “
coldcc
” - The cold calling convention - This calling convention attempts to make code in the caller as efficient as possible under the assumption that the call is not commonly executed. As such, these calls often preserve all registers so that the call does not break any live ranges in the caller side. This calling convention does not support varargs and requires the prototype of all callees to exactly match the prototype of the function definition. Furthermore the inliner doesn’t consider such function calls for inlining.
- “
cc 10
” - GHC convention This calling convention has been implemented specifically for use by the Glasgow Haskell Compiler (GHC). It passes everything in registers, going to extremes to achieve this by disabling callee save registers. This calling convention should not be used lightly but only for specific situations such as an alternative to the register pinning performance technique often used when implementing functional programming languages. At the moment only X86 supports this convention and it has the following limitations:
- On X86-32 only supports up to 4 bit type parameters. No floating point types are supported.
- On X86-64 only supports up to 10 bit type parameters and 6 floating point parameters.
This calling convention supports tail call optimization but requires both the caller and callee are using it.
- “
cc 11
” - The HiPE calling convention - This calling convention has been implemented specifically for use by the High-Performance Erlang (HiPE) compiler, the native code compiler of the Ericsson’s Open Source Erlang/OTP system. It uses more registers for argument passing than the ordinary C calling convention and defines no callee-saved registers. The calling convention properly supports tail call optimization but requires that both the caller and the callee use it. It uses a register pinning mechanism, similar to GHC’s convention, for keeping frequently accessed runtime components pinned to specific hardware registers. At the moment only X86 supports this convention (both 32 and 64 bit).
- “
webkit_jscc
” - WebKit’s JavaScript calling convention - This calling convention has been implemented for WebKit FTL JIT. It passes arguments on the stack right to left (as cdecl does), and returns a value in the platform’s customary return register.
- “
anyregcc
” - Dynamic calling convention for code patching - This is a special convention that supports patching an arbitrary code sequence in place of a call site. This convention forces the call arguments into registers but allows them to be dynamically allocated. This can currently only be used with calls to llvm.experimental.patchpoint because only this intrinsic records the location of its arguments in a side table. See Stack maps and patch points in LLVM.
- “
preserve_mostcc
” - The PreserveMost calling convention This calling convention attempts to make the code in the caller as unintrusive as possible. This convention behaves identically to the C calling convention on how arguments and return values are passed, but it uses a different set of caller/callee-saved registers. This alleviates the burden of saving and recovering a large register set before and after the call in the caller. If the arguments are passed in callee-saved registers, then they will be preserved by the callee across the call. This doesn’t apply for values returned in callee-saved registers.
- On X86-64 the callee preserves all general purpose registers, except for R11. R11 can be used as a scratch register. Floating-point registers (XMMs/YMMs) are not preserved and need to be saved by the caller.
The idea behind this convention is to support calls to runtime functions that have a hot path and a cold path. The hot path is usually a small piece of code that doesn’t use many registers. The cold path might need to call out to another function and therefore only needs to preserve the caller-saved registers, which haven’t already been saved by the caller. The PreserveMost calling convention is very similar to the cold calling convention in terms of caller/callee-saved registers, but they are used for different types of function calls. coldcc is for function calls that are rarely executed, whereas preserve_mostcc function calls are intended to be on the hot path and definitely executed a lot. Furthermore preserve_mostcc doesn’t prevent the inliner from inlining the function call.
This calling convention will be used by a future version of the ObjectiveC runtime and should therefore still be considered experimental at this time. Although this convention was created to optimize certain runtime calls to the ObjectiveC runtime, it is not limited to this runtime and might be used by other runtimes in the future too. The current implementation only supports X86-64, but the intention is to support more architectures in the future.
- “
preserve_allcc
” - The PreserveAll calling convention This calling convention attempts to make the code in the caller even less intrusive than the PreserveMost calling convention. This calling convention also behaves identical to the C calling convention on how arguments and return values are passed, but it uses a different set of caller/callee-saved registers. This removes the burden of saving and recovering a large register set before and after the call in the caller. If the arguments are passed in callee-saved registers, then they will be preserved by the callee across the call. This doesn’t apply for values returned in callee-saved registers.
- On X86-64 the callee preserves all general purpose registers, except for R11. R11 can be used as a scratch register. Furthermore it also preserves all floating-point registers (XMMs/YMMs).
The idea behind this convention is to support calls to runtime functions that don’t need to call out to any other functions.
This calling convention, like the PreserveMost calling convention, will be used by a future version of the ObjectiveC runtime and should be considered experimental at this time.
- “
cxx_fast_tlscc
” - The CXX_FAST_TLS calling convention for access functions Clang generates an access function to access C++-style TLS. The access function generally has an entry block, an exit block and an initialization block that is run at the first time. The entry and exit blocks can access a few TLS IR variables, each access will be lowered to a platform-specific sequence.
This calling convention aims to minimize overhead in the caller by preserving as many registers as possible (all the registers that are perserved on the fast path, composed of the entry and exit blocks).
This calling convention behaves identical to the C calling convention on how arguments and return values are passed, but it uses a different set of caller/callee-saved registers.
Given that each platform has its own lowering sequence, hence its own set of preserved registers, we can’t use the existing PreserveMost.
- On X86-64 the callee preserves all general purpose registers, except for RDI and RAX.
- “
cc <n>
” - Numbered convention - Any calling convention may be specified by number, allowing target-specific calling conventions to be used. Target specific calling conventions start at 64.
More calling conventions can be added/defined on an as-needed basis, to support Pascal conventions or any other well-known target-independent convention.
Visibility Styles¶
All Global Variables and Functions have one of the following visibility styles:
- “
default
” - Default style - On targets that use the ELF object file format, default visibility means that the declaration is visible to other modules and, in shared libraries, means that the declared entity may be overridden. On Darwin, default visibility means that the declaration is visible to other modules. Default visibility corresponds to “external linkage” in the language.
- “
hidden
” - Hidden style - Two declarations of an object with hidden visibility refer to the same object if they are in the same shared object. Usually, hidden visibility indicates that the symbol will not be placed into the dynamic symbol table, so no other module (executable or shared library) can reference it directly.
- “
protected
” - Protected style - On ELF, protected visibility indicates that the symbol will be placed in the dynamic symbol table, but that references within the defining module will bind to the local symbol. That is, the symbol cannot be overridden by another module.
A symbol with internal
or private
linkage must have default
visibility.
DLL Storage Classes¶
All Global Variables, Functions and Aliases can have one of the following DLL storage class:
dllimport
- “
dllimport
” causes the compiler to reference a function or variable via a global pointer to a pointer that is set up by the DLL exporting the symbol. On Microsoft Windows targets, the pointer name is formed by combining__imp_
and the function or variable name. dllexport
- “
dllexport
” causes the compiler to provide a global pointer to a pointer in a DLL, so that it can be referenced with thedllimport
attribute. On Microsoft Windows targets, the pointer name is formed by combining__imp_
and the function or variable name. Since this storage class exists for defining a dll interface, the compiler, assembler and linker know it is externally referenced and must refrain from deleting the symbol.
Thread Local Storage Models¶
A variable may be defined as thread_local
, which means that it will
not be shared by threads (each thread will have a separated copy of the
variable). Not all targets support thread-local variables. Optionally, a
TLS model may be specified:
localdynamic
- For variables that are only used within the current shared library.
initialexec
- For variables in modules that will not be loaded dynamically.
localexec
- For variables defined in the executable and only used within it.
If no explicit model is given, the “general dynamic” model is used.
The models correspond to the ELF TLS models; see ELF Handling For Thread-Local Storage for more information on under which circumstances the different models may be used. The target may choose a different TLS model if the specified model is not supported, or if a better choice of model can be made.
A model can also be specified in an alias, but then it only governs how the alias is accessed. It will not have any effect in the aliasee.
For platforms without linker support of ELF TLS model, the -femulated-tls flag can be used to generate GCC compatible emulated TLS code.
Structure Types¶
LLVM IR allows you to specify both “identified” and “literal” structure types. Literal types are uniqued structurally, but identified types are never uniqued. An opaque structural type can also be used to forward declare a type that is not yet available.
An example of an identified structure specification is:
%mytype = type { %mytype*, i32 }
Prior to the LLVM 3.0 release, identified types were structurally uniqued. Only literal types are uniqued in recent versions of LLVM.
Global Variables¶
Global variables define regions of memory allocated at compilation time instead of run-time.
Global variable definitions must be initialized.
Global variables in other translation units can also be declared, in which case they don’t have an initializer.
Either global variable definitions or declarations may have an explicit section to be placed in and may have an optional explicit alignment specified.
A variable may be defined as a global constant
, which indicates that
the contents of the variable will never be modified (enabling better
optimization, allowing the global data to be placed in the read-only
section of an executable, etc). Note that variables that need runtime
initialization cannot be marked constant
as there is a store to the
variable.
LLVM explicitly allows declarations of global variables to be marked constant, even if the final definition of the global is not. This capability can be used to enable slightly better optimization of the program, but requires the language definition to guarantee that optimizations based on the ‘constantness’ are valid for the translation units that do not include the definition.
As SSA values, global variables define pointer values that are in scope (i.e. they dominate) all basic blocks in the program. Global variables always define a pointer to their “content” type because they describe a region of memory, and all memory objects in LLVM are accessed through pointers.
Global variables can be marked with unnamed_addr
which indicates
that the address is not significant, only the content. Constants marked
like this can be merged with other constants if they have the same
initializer. Note that a constant with significant address can be
merged with a unnamed_addr
constant, the result being a constant
whose address is significant.
A global variable may be declared to reside in a target-specific numbered address space. For targets that support them, address spaces may affect how optimizations are performed and/or what target instructions are used to access the variable. The default address space is zero. The address space qualifier must precede any other attributes.
LLVM allows an explicit section to be specified for globals. If the target supports it, it will emit globals to the section specified. Additionally, the global can placed in a comdat if the target has the necessary support.
By default, global initializers are optimized by assuming that global
variables defined within the module are not modified from their
initial values before the start of the global initializer. This is
true even for variables potentially accessible from outside the
module, including those with external linkage or appearing in
@llvm.used
or dllexported variables. This assumption may be suppressed
by marking the variable with externally_initialized
.
An explicit alignment may be specified for a global, which must be a
power of 2. If not present, or if the alignment is set to zero, the
alignment of the global is set by the target to whatever it feels
convenient. If an explicit alignment is specified, the global is forced
to have exactly that alignment. Targets and optimizers are not allowed
to over-align the global if the global has an assigned section. In this
case, the extra alignment could be observable: for example, code could
assume that the globals are densely packed in their section and try to
iterate over them as an array, alignment padding would break this
iteration. The maximum alignment is 1 << 29
.
Globals can also have a DLL storage class.
Variables and aliases can have a Thread Local Storage Model.
Syntax:
[@<GlobalVarName> =] [Linkage] [Visibility] [DLLStorageClass] [ThreadLocal]
[unnamed_addr] [AddrSpace] [ExternallyInitialized]
<global | constant> <Type> [<InitializerConstant>]
[, section "name"] [, comdat [($name)]]
[, align <Alignment>]
For example, the following defines a global in a numbered address space with an initializer, section, and alignment:
@G = addrspace(5) constant float 1.0, section "foo", align 4
The following example just declares a global variable
@G = external global i32
The following example defines a thread-local global with the
initialexec
TLS model:
@G = thread_local(initialexec) global i32 0, align 4
Functions¶
LLVM function definitions consist of the “define
” keyword, an
optional linkage type, an optional visibility
style, an optional DLL storage class,
an optional calling convention,
an optional unnamed_addr
attribute, a return type, an optional
parameter attribute for the return type, a function
name, a (possibly empty) argument list (each with optional parameter
attributes), optional function attributes,
an optional section, an optional alignment,
an optional comdat,
an optional garbage collector name, an optional prefix,
an optional prologue,
an optional personality,
an optional list of attached metadata,
an opening curly brace, a list of basic blocks, and a closing curly brace.
LLVM function declarations consist of the “declare
” keyword, an
optional linkage type, an optional visibility
style, an optional DLL storage class,
an optional calling convention,
an optional unnamed_addr
attribute, a return type, an optional
parameter attribute for the return type, a function
name, a possibly empty list of arguments, an optional alignment, an optional
garbage collector name, an optional prefix,
and an optional prologue.
A function definition contains a list of basic blocks, forming the CFG (Control Flow Graph) for the function. Each basic block may optionally start with a label (giving the basic block a symbol table entry), contains a list of instructions, and ends with a terminator instruction (such as a branch or function return). If an explicit label is not provided, a block is assigned an implicit numbered label, using the next value from the same counter as used for unnamed temporaries (see above). For example, if a function entry block does not have an explicit label, it will be assigned label “%0”, then the first unnamed temporary in that block will be “%1”, etc.
The first basic block in a function is special in two ways: it is immediately executed on entrance to the function, and it is not allowed to have predecessor basic blocks (i.e. there can not be any branches to the entry block of a function). Because the block can have no predecessors, it also cannot have any PHI nodes.
LLVM allows an explicit section to be specified for functions. If the target supports it, it will emit functions to the section specified. Additionally, the function can be placed in a COMDAT.
An explicit alignment may be specified for a function. If not present, or if the alignment is set to zero, the alignment of the function is set by the target to whatever it feels convenient. If an explicit alignment is specified, the function is forced to have at least that much alignment. All alignments must be a power of 2.
If the unnamed_addr
attribute is given, the address is known to not
be significant and two identical functions can be merged.
Syntax:
define [linkage] [visibility] [DLLStorageClass]
[cconv] [ret attrs]
<ResultType> @<FunctionName> ([argument list])
[unnamed_addr] [fn Attrs] [section "name"] [comdat [($name)]]
[align N] [gc] [prefix Constant] [prologue Constant]
[personality Constant] (!name !N)* { ... }
The argument list is a comma separated sequence of arguments where each argument is of the following form:
Syntax:
<type> [parameter Attrs] [name]
Aliases¶
Aliases, unlike function or variables, don’t create any new data. They are just a new symbol and metadata for an existing position.
Aliases have a name and an aliasee that is either a global value or a constant expression.
Aliases may have an optional linkage type, an optional visibility style, an optional DLL storage class and an optional tls model.
Syntax:
@<Name> = [Linkage] [Visibility] [DLLStorageClass] [ThreadLocal] [unnamed_addr] alias <AliaseeTy>, <AliaseeTy>* @<Aliasee>
The linkage must be one of private
, internal
, linkonce
, weak
,
linkonce_odr
, weak_odr
, external
. Note that some system linkers
might not correctly handle dropping a weak symbol that is aliased.
Aliases that are not unnamed_addr
are guaranteed to have the same address as
the aliasee expression. unnamed_addr
ones are only guaranteed to point
to the same content.
Since aliases are only a second name, some restrictions apply, of which some can only be checked when producing an object file:
- The expression defining the aliasee must be computable at assembly time. Since it is just a name, no relocations can be used.
- No alias in the expression can be weak as the possibility of the intermediate alias being overridden cannot be represented in an object file.
- No global value in the expression can be a declaration, since that would require a relocation, which is not possible.
Comdats¶
Comdat IR provides access to COFF and ELF object file COMDAT functionality.
Comdats have a name which represents the COMDAT key. All global objects that specify this key will only end up in the final object file if the linker chooses that key over some other key. Aliases are placed in the same COMDAT that their aliasee computes to, if any.
Comdats have a selection kind to provide input on how the linker should choose between keys in two different object files.
Syntax:
$<Name> = comdat SelectionKind
The selection kind must be one of the following:
any
- The linker may choose any COMDAT key, the choice is arbitrary.
exactmatch
- The linker may choose any COMDAT key but the sections must contain the same data.
largest
- The linker will choose the section containing the largest COMDAT key.
noduplicates
- The linker requires that only section with this COMDAT key exist.
samesize
- The linker may choose any COMDAT key but the sections must contain the same amount of data.
Note that the Mach-O platform doesn’t support COMDATs and ELF only supports
any
as a selection kind.
Here is an example of a COMDAT group where a function will only be selected if the COMDAT key’s section is the largest:
$foo = comdat largest
@foo = global i32 2, comdat($foo)
define void @bar() comdat($foo) {
ret void
}
As a syntactic sugar the $name
can be omitted if the name is the same as
the global name:
$foo = comdat any
@foo = global i32 2, comdat
In a COFF object file, this will create a COMDAT section with selection kind
IMAGE_COMDAT_SELECT_LARGEST
containing the contents of the @foo
symbol
and another COMDAT section with selection kind
IMAGE_COMDAT_SELECT_ASSOCIATIVE
which is associated with the first COMDAT
section and contains the contents of the @bar
symbol.
There are some restrictions on the properties of the global object. It, or an alias to it, must have the same name as the COMDAT group when targeting COFF. The contents and size of this object may be used during link-time to determine which COMDAT groups get selected depending on the selection kind. Because the name of the object must match the name of the COMDAT group, the linkage of the global object must not be local; local symbols can get renamed if a collision occurs in the symbol table.
The combined use of COMDATS and section attributes may yield surprising results. For example:
$foo = comdat any
$bar = comdat any
@g1 = global i32 42, section "sec", comdat($foo)
@g2 = global i32 42, section "sec", comdat($bar)
From the object file perspective, this requires the creation of two sections with the same name. This is necessary because both globals belong to different COMDAT groups and COMDATs, at the object file level, are represented by sections.
Note that certain IR constructs like global variables and functions may create COMDATs in the object file in addition to any which are specified using COMDAT IR. This arises when the code generator is configured to emit globals in individual sections (e.g. when -data-sections or -function-sections is supplied to llc).
Named Metadata¶
Named metadata is a collection of metadata. Metadata nodes (but not metadata strings) are the only valid operands for a named metadata.
- Named metadata are represented as a string of characters with the
metadata prefix. The rules for metadata names are the same as for
identifiers, but quoted names are not allowed.
"\xx"
type escapes are still valid, which allows any character to be part of a name.
Syntax:
; Some unnamed metadata nodes, which are referenced by the named metadata.
!0 = !{!"zero"}
!1 = !{!"one"}
!2 = !{!"two"}
; A named metadata.
!name = !{!0, !1, !2}
Parameter Attributes¶
The return type and each parameter of a function type may have a set of parameter attributes associated with them. Parameter attributes are used to communicate additional information about the result or parameters of a function. Parameter attributes are considered to be part of the function, not of the function type, so functions with different parameter attributes can have the same function type.
Parameter attributes are simple keywords that follow the type specified. If multiple parameter attributes are needed, they are space separated. For example:
declare i32 @printf(i8* noalias nocapture, ...)
declare i32 @atoi(i8 zeroext)
declare signext i8 @returns_signed_char()
Note that any attributes for the function result (nounwind
,
readonly
) come immediately after the argument list.
Currently, only the following parameter attributes are defined:
zeroext
- This indicates to the code generator that the parameter or return value should be zero-extended to the extent required by the target’s ABI by the caller (for a parameter) or the callee (for a return value).
signext
- This indicates to the code generator that the parameter or return value should be sign-extended to the extent required by the target’s ABI (which is usually 32-bits) by the caller (for a parameter) or the callee (for a return value).
inreg
- This indicates that this parameter or return value should be treated in a special target-dependent fashion while emitting code for a function call or return (usually, by putting it in a register as opposed to memory, though some targets use it to distinguish between two different kinds of registers). Use of this attribute is target-specific.
byval
This indicates that the pointer parameter should really be passed by value to the function. The attribute implies that a hidden copy of the pointee is made between the caller and the callee, so the callee is unable to modify the value in the caller. This attribute is only valid on LLVM pointer arguments. It is generally used to pass structs and arrays by value, but is also valid on pointers to scalars. The copy is considered to belong to the caller not the callee (for example,
readonly
functions should not write tobyval
parameters). This is not a valid attribute for return values.The byval attribute also supports specifying an alignment with the align attribute. It indicates the alignment of the stack slot to form and the known alignment of the pointer specified to the call site. If the alignment is not specified, then the code generator makes a target-specific assumption.
inalloca
The
inalloca
argument attribute allows the caller to take the address of outgoing stack arguments. Aninalloca
argument must be a pointer to stack memory produced by analloca
instruction. The alloca, or argument allocation, must also be tagged with the inalloca keyword. Only the last argument may have theinalloca
attribute, and that argument is guaranteed to be passed in memory.An argument allocation may be used by a call at most once because the call may deallocate it. The
inalloca
attribute cannot be used in conjunction with other attributes that affect argument storage, likeinreg
,nest
,sret
, orbyval
. Theinalloca
attribute also disables LLVM’s implicit lowering of large aggregate return values, which means that frontend authors must lower them withsret
pointers.When the call site is reached, the argument allocation must have been the most recent stack allocation that is still live, or the results are undefined. It is possible to allocate additional stack space after an argument allocation and before its call site, but it must be cleared off with llvm.stackrestore.
See Design and Usage of the InAlloca Attribute for more information on how to use this attribute.
sret
- This indicates that the pointer parameter specifies the address of a structure that is the return value of the function in the source program. This pointer must be guaranteed by the caller to be valid: loads and stores to the structure may be assumed by the callee not to trap and to be properly aligned. This may only be applied to the first parameter. This is not a valid attribute for return values.
align <n>
This indicates that the pointer value may be assumed by the optimizer to have the specified alignment.
Note that this attribute has additional semantics when combined with the
byval
attribute.
noalias
This indicates that objects accessed via pointer values based on the argument or return value are not also accessed, during the execution of the function, via pointer values not based on the argument or return value. The attribute on a return value also has additional semantics described below. The caller shares the responsibility with the callee for ensuring that these requirements are met. For further details, please see the discussion of the NoAlias response in alias analysis.
Note that this definition of
noalias
is intentionally similar to the definition ofrestrict
in C99 for function arguments.For function return values, C99’s
restrict
is not meaningful, while LLVM’snoalias
is. Furthermore, the semantics of thenoalias
attribute on return values are stronger than the semantics of the attribute when used on function arguments. On function return values, thenoalias
attribute indicates that the function acts like a system memory allocation function, returning a pointer to allocated storage disjoint from the storage for any other object accessible to the caller.nocapture
- This indicates that the callee does not make any copies of the pointer that outlive the callee itself. This is not a valid attribute for return values.
nest
- This indicates that the pointer parameter can be excised using the trampoline intrinsics. This is not a valid attribute for return values and can only be applied to one parameter.
returned
- This indicates that the function always returns the argument as its return value. This is an optimization hint to the code generator when generating the caller, allowing tail call optimization and omission of register saves and restores in some cases; it is not checked or enforced when generating the callee. The parameter and the function return type must be valid operands for the bitcast instruction. This is not a valid attribute for return values and can only be applied to one parameter.
nonnull
- This indicates that the parameter or return pointer is not null. This attribute may only be applied to pointer typed parameters. This is not checked or enforced by LLVM, the caller must ensure that the pointer passed in is non-null, or the callee must ensure that the returned pointer is non-null.
dereferenceable(<n>)
- This indicates that the parameter or return pointer is dereferenceable. This
attribute may only be applied to pointer typed parameters. A pointer that
is dereferenceable can be loaded from speculatively without a risk of
trapping. The number of bytes known to be dereferenceable must be provided
in parentheses. It is legal for the number of bytes to be less than the
size of the pointee type. The
nonnull
attribute does not imply dereferenceability (consider a pointer to one element past the end of an array), howeverdereferenceable(<n>)
does implynonnull
inaddrspace(0)
(which is the default address space). dereferenceable_or_null(<n>)
- This indicates that the parameter or return value isn’t both
non-null and non-dereferenceable (up to
<n>
bytes) at the same time. All non-null pointers tagged withdereferenceable_or_null(<n>)
aredereferenceable(<n>)
. For address space 0dereferenceable_or_null(<n>)
implies that a pointer is exactly one ofdereferenceable(<n>)
ornull
, and in other address spacesdereferenceable_or_null(<n>)
implies that a pointer is at least one ofdereferenceable(<n>)
ornull
(i.e. it may be bothnull
anddereferenceable(<n>)
). This attribute may only be applied to pointer typed parameters. swiftself
- This indicates that the parameter is the self/context parameter. This is not a valid attribute for return values and can only be applied to one parameter.
swifterror
This attribute is motivated to model and optimize Swift error handling. It can be applied to a parameter with pointer to pointer type or a pointer-sized alloca. At the call site, the actual argument that corresponds to a
swifterror
parameter has to come from aswifterror
alloca. Aswifterror
value (either the parameter or the alloca) can only be loaded and stored from, or used as aswifterror
argument. This is not a valid attribute for return values and can only be applied to one parameter.These constraints allow the calling convention to optimize access to
swifterror
variables by associating them with a specific register at call boundaries rather than placing them in memory. Since this does change the calling convention, a function which uses theswifterror
attribute on a parameter is not ABI-compatible with one which does not.These constraints also allow LLVM to assume that a
swifterror
argument does not alias any other memory visible within a function and that aswifterror
alloca passed as an argument does not escape.
Garbage Collector Strategy Names¶
Each function may specify a garbage collector strategy name, which is simply a string:
define void @f() gc "name" { ... }
The supported values of name includes those built in to LLVM and any provided by loaded plugins. Specifying a GC strategy will cause the compiler to alter its output in order to support the named garbage collection algorithm. Note that LLVM itself does not contain a garbage collector, this functionality is restricted to generating machine code which can interoperate with a collector provided externally.
Prefix Data¶
Prefix data is data associated with a function which the code generator will emit immediately before the function’s entrypoint. The purpose of this feature is to allow frontends to associate language-specific runtime metadata with specific functions and make it available through the function pointer while still allowing the function pointer to be called.
To access the data for a given function, a program may bitcast the
function pointer to a pointer to the constant’s type and dereference
index -1. This implies that the IR symbol points just past the end of
the prefix data. For instance, take the example of a function annotated
with a single i32
,
define void @f() prefix i32 123 { ... }
The prefix data can be referenced as,
%0 = bitcast void* () @f to i32*
%a = getelementptr inbounds i32, i32* %0, i32 -1
%b = load i32, i32* %a
Prefix data is laid out as if it were an initializer for a global variable of the prefix data’s type. The function will be placed such that the beginning of the prefix data is aligned. This means that if the size of the prefix data is not a multiple of the alignment size, the function’s entrypoint will not be aligned. If alignment of the function’s entrypoint is desired, padding must be added to the prefix data.
A function may have prefix data but no body. This has similar semantics
to the available_externally
linkage in that the data may be used by the
optimizers but will not be emitted in the object file.
Prologue Data¶
The prologue
attribute allows arbitrary code (encoded as bytes) to
be inserted prior to the function body. This can be used for enabling
function hot-patching and instrumentation.
To maintain the semantics of ordinary function calls, the prologue data must have a particular format. Specifically, it must begin with a sequence of bytes which decode to a sequence of machine instructions, valid for the module’s target, which transfer control to the point immediately succeeding the prologue data, without performing any other visible action. This allows the inliner and other passes to reason about the semantics of the function definition without needing to reason about the prologue data. Obviously this makes the format of the prologue data highly target dependent.
A trivial example of valid prologue data for the x86 architecture is i8 144
,
which encodes the nop
instruction:
define void @f() prologue i8 144 { ... }
Generally prologue data can be formed by encoding a relative branch instruction
which skips the metadata, as in this example of valid prologue data for the
x86_64 architecture, where the first two bytes encode jmp .+10
:
%0 = type <{ i8, i8, i8* }>
define void @f() prologue %0 <{ i8 235, i8 8, i8* @md}> { ... }
A function may have prologue data but no body. This has similar semantics
to the available_externally
linkage in that the data may be used by the
optimizers but will not be emitted in the object file.
Personality Function¶
The personality
attribute permits functions to specify what function
to use for exception handling.
Attribute Groups¶
Attribute groups are groups of attributes that are referenced by objects within
the IR. They are important for keeping .ll
files readable, because a lot of
functions will use the same set of attributes. In the degenerative case of a
.ll
file that corresponds to a single .c
file, the single attribute
group will capture the important command line flags used to build that file.
An attribute group is a module-level object. To use an attribute group, an
object references the attribute group’s ID (e.g. #37
). An object may refer
to more than one attribute group. In that situation, the attributes from the
different groups are merged.
Here is an example of attribute groups for a function that should always be inlined, has a stack alignment of 4, and which shouldn’t use SSE instructions:
; Target-independent attributes:
attributes #0 = { alwaysinline alignstack=4 }
; Target-dependent attributes:
attributes #1 = { "no-sse" }
; Function @f has attributes: alwaysinline, alignstack=4, and "no-sse".
define void @f() #0 #1 { ... }
Function Attributes¶
Function attributes are set to communicate additional information about a function. Function attributes are considered to be part of the function, not of the function type, so functions with different function attributes can have the same function type.
Function attributes are simple keywords that follow the type specified. If multiple attributes are needed, they are space separated. For example:
define void @f() noinline { ... }
define void @f() alwaysinline { ... }
define void @f() alwaysinline optsize { ... }
define void @f() optsize { ... }
alignstack(<n>)
- This attribute indicates that, when emitting the prologue and epilogue, the backend should forcibly align the stack pointer. Specify the desired alignment, which must be a power of two, in parentheses.
alwaysinline
- This attribute indicates that the inliner should attempt to inline this function into callers whenever possible, ignoring any active inlining size threshold for this caller.
builtin
- This indicates that the callee function at a call site should be
recognized as a built-in function, even though the function’s declaration
uses the
nobuiltin
attribute. This is only valid at call sites for direct calls to functions that are declared with thenobuiltin
attribute. cold
- This attribute indicates that this function is rarely called. When computing edge weights, basic blocks post-dominated by a cold function call are also considered to be cold; and, thus, given low weight.
convergent
In some parallel execution models, there exist operations that cannot be made control-dependent on any additional values. We call such operations
convergent
, and mark them with this attribute.The
convergent
attribute may appear on functions or call/invoke instructions. When it appears on a function, it indicates that calls to this function should not be made control-dependent on additional values. For example, the intrinsicllvm.cuda.syncthreads
isconvergent
, so calls to this intrinsic cannot be made control-dependent on additional values.When it appears on a call/invoke, the
convergent
attribute indicates that we should treat the call as though we’re calling a convergent function. This is particularly useful on indirect calls; without this we may treat such calls as though the target is non-convergent.The optimizer may remove the
convergent
attribute on functions when it can prove that the function does not execute any convergent operations. Similarly, the optimizer may removeconvergent
on calls/invokes when it can prove that the call/invoke cannot call a convergent function.inaccessiblememonly
- This attribute indicates that the function may only access memory that
is not accessible by the module being compiled. This is a weaker form
of
readnone
. inaccessiblemem_or_argmemonly
- This attribute indicates that the function may only access memory that is
either not accessible by the module being compiled, or is pointed to
by its pointer arguments. This is a weaker form of
argmemonly
inlinehint
- This attribute indicates that the source code contained a hint that inlining this function is desirable (such as the “inline” keyword in C/C++). It is just a hint; it imposes no requirements on the inliner.
jumptable
- This attribute indicates that the function should be added to a
jump-instruction table at code-generation time, and that all address-taken
references to this function should be replaced with a reference to the
appropriate jump-instruction-table function pointer. Note that this creates
a new pointer for the original function, which means that code that depends
on function-pointer identity can break. So, any function annotated with
jumptable
must also beunnamed_addr
. minsize
- This attribute suggests that optimization passes and code generator passes make choices that keep the code size of this function as small as possible and perform optimizations that may sacrifice runtime performance in order to minimize the size of the generated code.
naked
- This attribute disables prologue / epilogue emission for the function. This can have very system-specific consequences.
nobuiltin
- This indicates that the callee function at a call site is not recognized as
a built-in function. LLVM will retain the original call and not replace it
with equivalent code based on the semantics of the built-in function, unless
the call site uses the
builtin
attribute. This is valid at call sites and on function declarations and definitions. noduplicate
This attribute indicates that calls to the function cannot be duplicated. A call to a
noduplicate
function may be moved within its parent function, but may not be duplicated within its parent function.A function containing a
noduplicate
call may still be an inlining candidate, provided that the call is not duplicated by inlining. That implies that the function has internal linkage and only has one call site, so the original call is dead after inlining.noimplicitfloat
- This attributes disables implicit floating point instructions.
noinline
- This attribute indicates that the inliner should never inline this
function in any situation. This attribute may not be used together
with the
alwaysinline
attribute. nonlazybind
- This attribute suppresses lazy symbol binding for the function. This may make calls to the function faster, at the cost of extra program startup time if the function is not called during program startup.
noredzone
- This attribute indicates that the code generator should not use a red zone, even if the target-specific ABI normally permits it.
noreturn
- This function attribute indicates that the function never returns normally. This produces undefined behavior at runtime if the function ever does dynamically return.
norecurse
- This function attribute indicates that the function does not call itself either directly or indirectly down any possible call path. This produces undefined behavior at runtime if the function ever does recurse.
nounwind
- This function attribute indicates that the function never raises an exception. If the function does raise an exception, its runtime behavior is undefined. However, functions marked nounwind may still trap or generate asynchronous exceptions. Exception handling schemes that are recognized by LLVM to handle asynchronous exceptions, such as SEH, will still provide their implementation defined semantics.
optnone
This function attribute indicates that most optimization passes will skip this function, with the exception of interprocedural optimization passes. Code generation defaults to the “fast” instruction selector. This attribute cannot be used together with the
alwaysinline
attribute; this attribute is also incompatible with theminsize
attribute and theoptsize
attribute.This attribute requires the
noinline
attribute to be specified on the function as well, so the function is never inlined into any caller. Only functions with thealwaysinline
attribute are valid candidates for inlining into the body of this function.optsize
- This attribute suggests that optimization passes and code generator passes make choices that keep the code size of this function low, and otherwise do optimizations specifically to reduce code size as long as they do not significantly impact runtime performance.
readnone
On a function, this attribute indicates that the function computes its result (or decides to unwind an exception) based strictly on its arguments, without dereferencing any pointer arguments or otherwise accessing any mutable state (e.g. memory, control registers, etc) visible to caller functions. It does not write through any pointer arguments (including
byval
arguments) and never changes any state visible to callers. This means that it cannot unwind exceptions by calling theC++
exception throwing methods.On an argument, this attribute indicates that the function does not dereference that pointer argument, even though it may read or write the memory that the pointer points to if accessed through other pointers.
readonly
On a function, this attribute indicates that the function does not write through any pointer arguments (including
byval
arguments) or otherwise modify any state (e.g. memory, control registers, etc) visible to caller functions. It may dereference pointer arguments and read state that may be set in the caller. A readonly function always returns the same value (or unwinds an exception identically) when called with the same set of arguments and global state. It cannot unwind an exception by calling theC++
exception throwing methods.On an argument, this attribute indicates that the function does not write through this pointer argument, even though it may write to the memory that the pointer points to.
argmemonly
- This attribute indicates that the only memory accesses inside function are
loads and stores from objects pointed to by its pointer-typed arguments,
with arbitrary offsets. Or in other words, all memory operations in the
function can refer to memory only using pointers based on its function
arguments.
Note that
argmemonly
can be used together withreadonly
attribute in order to specify that function reads only from its arguments. returns_twice
- This attribute indicates that this function can return twice. The C
setjmp
is an example of such a function. The compiler disables some optimizations (like tail calls) in the caller of these functions. safestack
This attribute indicates that SafeStack protection is enabled for this function.
If a function that has a
safestack
attribute is inlined into a function that doesn’t have asafestack
attribute or which has anssp
,sspstrong
orsspreq
attribute, then the resulting function will have asafestack
attribute.sanitize_address
- This attribute indicates that AddressSanitizer checks (dynamic address safety analysis) are enabled for this function.
sanitize_memory
- This attribute indicates that MemorySanitizer checks (dynamic detection of accesses to uninitialized memory) are enabled for this function.
sanitize_thread
- This attribute indicates that ThreadSanitizer checks (dynamic thread safety analysis) are enabled for this function.
ssp
This attribute indicates that the function should emit a stack smashing protector. It is in the form of a “canary” — a random value placed on the stack before the local variables that’s checked upon return from the function to see if it has been overwritten. A heuristic is used to determine if a function needs stack protectors or not. The heuristic used will enable protectors for functions with:
- Character arrays larger than
ssp-buffer-size
(default 8). - Aggregates containing character arrays larger than
ssp-buffer-size
. - Calls to alloca() with variable sizes or constant sizes greater than
ssp-buffer-size
.
Variables that are identified as requiring a protector will be arranged on the stack such that they are adjacent to the stack protector guard.
If a function that has an
ssp
attribute is inlined into a function that doesn’t have anssp
attribute, then the resulting function will have anssp
attribute.- Character arrays larger than
sspreq
This attribute indicates that the function should always emit a stack smashing protector. This overrides the
ssp
function attribute.Variables that are identified as requiring a protector will be arranged on the stack such that they are adjacent to the stack protector guard. The specific layout rules are:
- Large arrays and structures containing large arrays
(
>= ssp-buffer-size
) are closest to the stack protector. - Small arrays and structures containing small arrays
(
< ssp-buffer-size
) are 2nd closest to the protector. - Variables that have had their address taken are 3rd closest to the protector.
If a function that has an
sspreq
attribute is inlined into a function that doesn’t have ansspreq
attribute or which has anssp
orsspstrong
attribute, then the resulting function will have ansspreq
attribute.- Large arrays and structures containing large arrays
(
sspstrong
This attribute indicates that the function should emit a stack smashing protector. This attribute causes a strong heuristic to be used when determining if a function needs stack protectors. The strong heuristic will enable protectors for functions with:
- Arrays of any size and type
- Aggregates containing an array of any size and type.
- Calls to alloca().
- Local variables that have had their address taken.
Variables that are identified as requiring a protector will be arranged on the stack such that they are adjacent to the stack protector guard. The specific layout rules are:
- Large arrays and structures containing large arrays
(
>= ssp-buffer-size
) are closest to the stack protector. - Small arrays and structures containing small arrays
(
< ssp-buffer-size
) are 2nd closest to the protector. - Variables that have had their address taken are 3rd closest to the protector.
This overrides the
ssp
function attribute.If a function that has an
sspstrong
attribute is inlined into a function that doesn’t have ansspstrong
attribute, then the resulting function will have ansspstrong
attribute."thunk"
- This attribute indicates that the function will delegate to some other function with a tail call. The prototype of a thunk should not be used for optimization purposes. The caller is expected to cast the thunk prototype to match the thunk target prototype.
uwtable
- This attribute indicates that the ABI being targeted requires that an unwind table entry be produced for this function even if we can show that no exceptions passes by it. This is normally the case for the ELF x86-64 abi, but it can be disabled for some compilation units.
Operand Bundles¶
Note: operand bundles are a work in progress, and they should be considered experimental at this time.
Operand bundles are tagged sets of SSA values that can be associated
with certain LLVM instructions (currently only call
s and
invoke
s). In a way they are like metadata, but dropping them is
incorrect and will change program semantics.
Syntax:
operand bundle set ::= '[' operand bundle (, operand bundle )* ']'
operand bundle ::= tag '(' [ bundle operand ] (, bundle operand )* ')'
bundle operand ::= SSA value
tag ::= string constant
Operand bundles are not part of a function’s signature, and a
given function may be called from multiple places with different kinds
of operand bundles. This reflects the fact that the operand bundles
are conceptually a part of the call
(or invoke
), not the
callee being dispatched to.
Operand bundles are a generic mechanism intended to support runtime-introspection-like functionality for managed languages. While the exact semantics of an operand bundle depend on the bundle tag, there are certain limitations to how much the presence of an operand bundle can influence the semantics of a program. These restrictions are described as the semantics of an “unknown” operand bundle. As long as the behavior of an operand bundle is describable within these restrictions, LLVM does not need to have special knowledge of the operand bundle to not miscompile programs containing it.
- The bundle operands for an unknown operand bundle escape in unknown ways before control is transferred to the callee or invokee.
- Calls and invokes with operand bundles have unknown read / write
effect on the heap on entry and exit (even if the call target is
readnone
orreadonly
), unless they’re overridden with callsite specific attributes. - An operand bundle at a call site cannot change the implementation of the called function. Inter-procedural optimizations work as usual as long as they take into account the first two properties.
More specific types of operand bundles are described below.
Deoptimization Operand Bundles¶
Deoptimization operand bundles are characterized by the "deopt"
operand bundle tag. These operand bundles represent an alternate
“safe” continuation for the call site they’re attached to, and can be
used by a suitable runtime to deoptimize the compiled frame at the
specified call site. There can be at most one "deopt"
operand
bundle attached to a call site. Exact details of deoptimization is
out of scope for the language reference, but it usually involves
rewriting a compiled frame into a set of interpreted frames.
From the compiler’s perspective, deoptimization operand bundles make
the call sites they’re attached to at least readonly
. They read
through all of their pointer typed operands (even if they’re not
otherwise escaped) and the entire visible heap. Deoptimization
operand bundles do not capture their operands except during
deoptimization, in which case control will not be returned to the
compiled frame.
The inliner knows how to inline through calls that have deoptimization
operand bundles. Just like inlining through a normal call site
involves composing the normal and exceptional continuations, inlining
through a call site with a deoptimization operand bundle needs to
appropriately compose the “safe” deoptimization continuation. The
inliner does this by prepending the parent’s deoptimization
continuation to every deoptimization continuation in the inlined body.
E.g. inlining @f
into @g
in the following example
define void @f() {
call void @x() ;; no deopt state
call void @y() [ "deopt"(i32 10) ]
call void @y() [ "deopt"(i32 10), "unknown"(i8* null) ]
ret void
}
define void @g() {
call void @f() [ "deopt"(i32 20) ]
ret void
}
will result in
define void @g() {
call void @x() ;; still no deopt state
call void @y() [ "deopt"(i32 20, i32 10) ]
call void @y() [ "deopt"(i32 20, i32 10), "unknown"(i8* null) ]
ret void
}
It is the frontend’s responsibility to structure or encode the deoptimization state in a way that syntactically prepending the caller’s deoptimization state to the callee’s deoptimization state is semantically equivalent to composing the caller’s deoptimization continuation after the callee’s deoptimization continuation.
Funclet Operand Bundles¶
Funclet operand bundles are characterized by the "funclet"
operand bundle tag. These operand bundles indicate that a call site
is within a particular funclet. There can be at most one
"funclet"
operand bundle attached to a call site and it must have
exactly one bundle operand.
If any funclet EH pads have been “entered” but not “exited” (per the
description in the EH doc),
it is undefined behavior to execute a call
or invoke
which:
- does not have a
"funclet"
bundle and is not acall
to a nounwind intrinsic, or - has a
"funclet"
bundle whose operand is not the most-recently-entered not-yet-exited funclet EH pad.
Similarly, if no funclet EH pads have been entered-but-not-yet-exited,
executing a call
or invoke
with a "funclet"
bundle is undefined behavior.
GC Transition Operand Bundles¶
GC transition operand bundles are characterized by the
"gc-transition"
operand bundle tag. These operand bundles mark a
call as a transition between a function with one GC strategy to a
function with a different GC strategy. If coordinating the transition
between GC strategies requires additional code generation at the call
site, these bundles may contain any values that are needed by the
generated code. For more details, see GC Transitions.
Module-Level Inline Assembly¶
Modules may contain “module-level inline asm” blocks, which corresponds
to the GCC “file scope inline asm” blocks. These blocks are internally
concatenated by LLVM and treated as a single unit, but may be separated
in the .ll
file if desired. The syntax is very simple:
module asm "inline asm code goes here"
module asm "more can go here"
The strings can contain any character by escaping non-printable characters. The escape sequence used is simply “\xx” where “xx” is the two digit hex code for the number.
Note that the assembly string must be parseable by LLVM’s integrated assembler
(unless it is disabled), even when emitting a .s
file.
Data Layout¶
A module may specify a target specific data layout string that specifies how data is to be laid out in memory. The syntax for the data layout is simply:
target datalayout = "layout specification"
The layout specification consists of a list of specifications separated by the minus sign character (‘-‘). Each specification starts with a letter and may include other information after the letter to define some aspect of the data layout. The specifications accepted are as follows:
E
- Specifies that the target lays out data in big-endian form. That is, the bits with the most significance have the lowest address location.
e
- Specifies that the target lays out data in little-endian form. That is, the bits with the least significance have the lowest address location.
S<size>
- Specifies the natural alignment of the stack in bits. Alignment promotion of stack variables is limited to the natural stack alignment to avoid dynamic stack realignment. The stack alignment must be a multiple of 8-bits. If omitted, the natural stack alignment defaults to “unspecified”, which does not prevent any alignment promotions.
p[n]:<size>:<abi>:<pref>
- This specifies the size of a pointer and its
<abi>
and<pref>
erred alignments for address spacen
. All sizes are in bits. The address space,n
, is optional, and if not specified, denotes the default address space 0. The value ofn
must be in the range [1,2^23). i<size>:<abi>:<pref>
- This specifies the alignment for an integer type of a given bit
<size>
. The value of<size>
must be in the range [1,2^23). v<size>:<abi>:<pref>
- This specifies the alignment for a vector type of a given bit
<size>
. f<size>:<abi>:<pref>
- This specifies the alignment for a floating point type of a given bit
<size>
. Only values of<size>
that are supported by the target will work. 32 (float) and 64 (double) are supported on all targets; 80 or 128 (different flavors of long double) are also supported on some targets. a:<abi>:<pref>
- This specifies the alignment for an object of aggregate type.
m:<mangling>
If present, specifies that llvm names are mangled in the output. The options are
e
: ELF mangling: Private symbols get a.L
prefix.m
: Mips mangling: Private symbols get a$
prefix.o
: Mach-O mangling: Private symbols getL
prefix. Other symbols get a_
prefix.w
: Windows COFF prefix: Similar to Mach-O, but stdcall and fastcall functions also get a suffix based on the frame size.x
: Windows x86 COFF prefix: Similar to Windows COFF, but use a_
prefix for__cdecl
functions.
n<size1>:<size2>:<size3>...
- This specifies a set of native integer widths for the target CPU in
bits. For example, it might contain
n32
for 32-bit PowerPC,n32:64
for PowerPC 64, orn8:16:32:64
for X86-64. Elements of this set are considered to support most general arithmetic operations efficiently.
On every specification that takes a <abi>:<pref>
, specifying the
<pref>
alignment is optional. If omitted, the preceding :
should be omitted too and <pref>
will be equal to <abi>
.
When constructing the data layout for a given target, LLVM starts with a
default set of specifications which are then (possibly) overridden by
the specifications in the datalayout
keyword. The default
specifications are given in this list:
E
- big endianp:64:64:64
- 64-bit pointers with 64-bit alignment.p[n]:64:64:64
- Other address spaces are assumed to be the same as the default address space.S0
- natural stack alignment is unspecifiedi1:8:8
- i1 is 8-bit (byte) alignedi8:8:8
- i8 is 8-bit (byte) alignedi16:16:16
- i16 is 16-bit alignedi32:32:32
- i32 is 32-bit alignedi64:32:64
- i64 has ABI alignment of 32-bits but preferred alignment of 64-bitsf16:16:16
- half is 16-bit alignedf32:32:32
- float is 32-bit alignedf64:64:64
- double is 64-bit alignedf128:128:128
- quad is 128-bit alignedv64:64:64
- 64-bit vector is 64-bit alignedv128:128:128
- 128-bit vector is 128-bit aligneda:0:64
- aggregates are 64-bit aligned
When LLVM is determining the alignment for a given type, it uses the following rules:
- If the type sought is an exact match for one of the specifications, that specification is used.
- If no match is found, and the type sought is an integer type, then the smallest integer type that is larger than the bitwidth of the sought type is used. If none of the specifications are larger than the bitwidth then the largest integer type is used. For example, given the default specifications above, the i7 type will use the alignment of i8 (next largest) while both i65 and i256 will use the alignment of i64 (largest specified).
- If no match is found, and the type sought is a vector type, then the largest vector type that is smaller than the sought vector type will be used as a fall back. This happens because <128 x double> can be implemented in terms of 64 <2 x double>, for example.
The function of the data layout string may not be what you expect. Notably, this is not a specification from the frontend of what alignment the code generator should use.
Instead, if specified, the target data layout is required to match what the ultimate code generator expects. This string is used by the mid-level optimizers to improve code, and this only works if it matches what the ultimate code generator uses. There is no way to generate IR that does not embed this target-specific detail into the IR. If you don’t specify the string, the default specifications will be used to generate a Data Layout and the optimization phases will operate accordingly and introduce target specificity into the IR with respect to these default specifications.
Target Triple¶
A module may specify a target triple string that describes the target host. The syntax for the target triple is simply:
target triple = "x86_64-apple-macosx10.7.0"
The target triple string consists of a series of identifiers delimited by the minus sign character (‘-‘). The canonical forms are:
ARCHITECTURE-VENDOR-OPERATING_SYSTEM
ARCHITECTURE-VENDOR-OPERATING_SYSTEM-ENVIRONMENT
This information is passed along to the backend so that it generates
code for the proper architecture. It’s possible to override this on the
command line with the -mtriple
command line option.
Pointer Aliasing Rules¶
Any memory access must be done through a pointer value associated with an address range of the memory access, otherwise the behavior is undefined. Pointer values are associated with address ranges according to the following rules:
- A pointer value is associated with the addresses associated with any value it is based on.
- An address of a global variable is associated with the address range of the variable’s storage.
- The result value of an allocation instruction is associated with the address range of the allocated storage.
- A null pointer in the default address-space is associated with no address.
- An integer constant other than zero or a pointer value returned from a function not defined within LLVM may be associated with address ranges allocated through mechanisms other than those provided by LLVM. Such ranges shall not overlap with any ranges of addresses allocated by mechanisms provided by LLVM.
A pointer value is based on another pointer value according to the following rules:
- A pointer value formed from a
getelementptr
operation is based on the first value operand of thegetelementptr
. - The result value of a
bitcast
is based on the operand of thebitcast
. - A pointer value formed by an
inttoptr
is based on all pointer values that contribute (directly or indirectly) to the computation of the pointer’s value. - The “based on” relationship is transitive.
Note that this definition of “based” is intentionally similar to the definition of “based” in C99, though it is slightly weaker.
LLVM IR does not associate types with memory. The result type of a
load
merely indicates the size and alignment of the memory from
which to load, as well as the interpretation of the value. The first
operand type of a store
similarly only indicates the size and
alignment of the store.
Consequently, type-based alias analysis, aka TBAA, aka
-fstrict-aliasing
, is not applicable to general unadorned LLVM IR.
Metadata may be used to encode additional information
which specialized optimization passes may use to implement type-based
alias analysis.
Volatile Memory Accesses¶
Certain memory accesses, such as load‘s,
store‘s, and llvm.memcpy‘s may be
marked volatile
. The optimizers must not change the number of
volatile operations or change their order of execution relative to other
volatile operations. The optimizers may change the order of volatile
operations relative to non-volatile operations. This is not Java’s
“volatile” and has no cross-thread synchronization behavior.
IR-level volatile loads and stores cannot safely be optimized into llvm.memcpy or llvm.memmove intrinsics even when those intrinsics are flagged volatile. Likewise, the backend should never split or merge target-legal volatile load/store instructions.
Rationale
Platforms may rely on volatile loads and stores of natively supported data width to be executed as single instruction. For example, in C this holds for an l-value of volatile primitive type with native hardware support, but not necessarily for aggregate types. The frontend upholds these expectations, which are intentionally unspecified in the IR. The rules above ensure that IR transformations do not violate the frontend’s contract with the language.
Memory Model for Concurrent Operations¶
The LLVM IR does not define any way to start parallel threads of execution or to register signal handlers. Nonetheless, there are platform-specific ways to create them, and we define LLVM IR’s behavior in their presence. This model is inspired by the C++0x memory model.
For a more informal introduction to this model, see the LLVM Atomic Instructions and Concurrency Guide.
We define a happens-before partial order as the least partial order that
- Is a superset of single-thread program order, and
- When a synchronizes-with
b
, includes an edge froma
tob
. Synchronizes-with pairs are introduced by platform-specific techniques, like pthread locks, thread creation, thread joining, etc., and by atomic instructions. (See also Atomic Memory Ordering Constraints).
Note that program order does not introduce happens-before edges between a thread and signals executing inside that thread.
Every (defined) read operation (load instructions, memcpy, atomic loads/read-modify-writes, etc.) R reads a series of bytes written by (defined) write operations (store instructions, atomic stores/read-modify-writes, memcpy, etc.). For the purposes of this section, initialized globals are considered to have a write of the initializer which is atomic and happens before any other read or write of the memory in question. For each byte of a read R, Rbyte may see any write to the same byte, except:
- If write1 happens before write2, and write2 happens before Rbyte, then Rbyte does not see write1.
- If Rbyte happens before write3, then Rbyte does not see write3.
Given that definition, Rbyte is defined as follows:
- If R is volatile, the result is target-dependent. (Volatile is
supposed to give guarantees which can support
sig_atomic_t
in C/C++, and may be used for accesses to addresses that do not behave like normal memory. It does not generally provide cross-thread synchronization.) - Otherwise, if there is no write to the same byte that happens before
Rbyte, Rbyte returns
undef
for that byte. - Otherwise, if Rbyte may see exactly one write, Rbyte returns the value written by that write.
- Otherwise, if R is atomic, and all the writes Rbyte may see are atomic, it chooses one of the values written. See the Atomic Memory Ordering Constraints section for additional constraints on how the choice is made.
- Otherwise Rbyte returns
undef
.
R returns the value composed of the series of bytes it read. This
implies that some bytes within the value may be undef
without
the entire value being undef
. Note that this only defines the
semantics of the operation; it doesn’t mean that targets will emit more
than one instruction to read the series of bytes.
Note that in cases where none of the atomic intrinsics are used, this model places only one restriction on IR transformations on top of what is required for single-threaded execution: introducing a store to a byte which might not otherwise be stored is not allowed in general. (Specifically, in the case where another thread might write to and read from an address, introducing a store can change a load that may see exactly one write into a load that may see multiple writes.)
Atomic Memory Ordering Constraints¶
Atomic instructions (cmpxchg, atomicrmw, fence, atomic load, and atomic store) take ordering parameters that determine which other atomic instructions on the same address they synchronize with. These semantics are borrowed from Java and C++0x, but are somewhat more colloquial. If these descriptions aren’t precise enough, check those specs (see spec references in the atomics guide). fence instructions treat these orderings somewhat differently since they don’t take an address. See that instruction’s documentation for details.
For a simpler introduction to the ordering constraints, see the LLVM Atomic Instructions and Concurrency Guide.
unordered
- The set of values that can be read is governed by the happens-before partial order. A value cannot be read unless some operation wrote it. This is intended to provide a guarantee strong enough to model Java’s non-volatile shared variables. This ordering cannot be specified for read-modify-write operations; it is not strong enough to make them atomic in any interesting way.
monotonic
- In addition to the guarantees of
unordered
, there is a single total order for modifications bymonotonic
operations on each address. All modification orders must be compatible with the happens-before order. There is no guarantee that the modification orders can be combined to a global total order for the whole program (and this often will not be possible). The read in an atomic read-modify-write operation (cmpxchg and atomicrmw) reads the value in the modification order immediately before the value it writes. If one atomic read happens before another atomic read of the same address, the later read must see the same value or a later value in the address’s modification order. This disallows reordering ofmonotonic
(or stronger) operations on the same address. If an address is writtenmonotonic
-ally by one thread, and other threadsmonotonic
-ally read that address repeatedly, the other threads must eventually see the write. This corresponds to the C++0x/C1xmemory_order_relaxed
. acquire
- In addition to the guarantees of
monotonic
, a synchronizes-with edge may be formed with arelease
operation. This is intended to model C++’smemory_order_acquire
. release
- In addition to the guarantees of
monotonic
, if this operation writes a value which is subsequently read by anacquire
operation, it synchronizes-with that operation. (This isn’t a complete description; see the C++0x definition of a release sequence.) This corresponds to the C++0x/C1xmemory_order_release
. acq_rel
(acquire+release)- Acts as both an
acquire
andrelease
operation on its address. This corresponds to the C++0x/C1xmemory_order_acq_rel
. seq_cst
(sequentially consistent)- In addition to the guarantees of
acq_rel
(acquire
for an operation that only reads,release
for an operation that only writes), there is a global total order on all sequentially-consistent operations on all addresses, which is consistent with the happens-before partial order and with the modification orders of all the affected addresses. Each sequentially-consistent read sees the last preceding write to the same address in this global order. This corresponds to the C++0x/C1xmemory_order_seq_cst
and Java volatile.
If an atomic operation is marked singlethread
, it only synchronizes
with or participates in modification and seq_cst total orderings with
other operations running in the same thread (for example, in signal
handlers).
Fast-Math Flags¶
LLVM IR floating-point binary ops (fadd, fsub, fmul, fdiv, frem, fcmp) have the following flags that can be set to enable otherwise unsafe floating point operations
nnan
- No NaNs - Allow optimizations to assume the arguments and result are not NaN. Such optimizations are required to retain defined behavior over NaNs, but the value of the result is undefined.
ninf
- No Infs - Allow optimizations to assume the arguments and result are not +/-Inf. Such optimizations are required to retain defined behavior over +/-Inf, but the value of the result is undefined.
nsz
- No Signed Zeros - Allow optimizations to treat the sign of a zero argument or result as insignificant.
arcp
- Allow Reciprocal - Allow optimizations to use the reciprocal of an argument rather than perform division.
fast
- Fast - Allow algebraically equivalent transformations that may dramatically change results in floating point (e.g. reassociate). This flag implies all the others.
Use-list Order Directives¶
Use-list directives encode the in-memory order of each use-list, allowing the
order to be recreated. <order-indexes>
is a comma-separated list of
indexes that are assigned to the referenced value’s uses. The referenced
value’s use-list is immediately sorted by these indexes.
Use-list directives may appear at function scope or global scope. They are not instructions, and have no effect on the semantics of the IR. When they’re at function scope, they must appear after the terminator of the final basic block.
If basic blocks have their address taken via blockaddress()
expressions,
uselistorder_bb
can be used to reorder their use-lists from outside their
function’s scope.
Syntax: |
---|
uselistorder <ty> <value>, { <order-indexes> }
uselistorder_bb @function, %block { <order-indexes> }
Examples: |
---|
define void @foo(i32 %arg1, i32 %arg2) {
entry:
; ... instructions ...
bb:
; ... instructions ...
; At function scope.
uselistorder i32 %arg1, { 1, 0, 2 }
uselistorder label %bb, { 1, 0 }
}
; At global scope.
uselistorder i32* @global, { 1, 2, 0 }
uselistorder i32 7, { 1, 0 }
uselistorder i32 (i32) @bar, { 1, 0 }
uselistorder_bb @foo, %bb, { 5, 1, 3, 2, 0, 4 }
Type System¶
The LLVM type system is one of the most important features of the intermediate representation. Being typed enables a number of optimizations to be performed on the intermediate representation directly, without having to do extra analyses on the side before the transformation. A strong type system makes it easier to read the generated code and enables novel analyses and transformations that are not feasible to perform on normal three address code representations.
Function Type¶
Overview: |
---|
The function type can be thought of as a function signature. It consists of a return type and a list of formal parameter types. The return type of a function type is a void type or first class type — except for label and metadata types.
Syntax: |
---|
<returntype> (<parameter list>)
...where ‘<parameter list>
‘ is a comma-separated list of type
specifiers. Optionally, the parameter list may include a type ...
, which
indicates that the function takes a variable number of arguments. Variable
argument functions can access their arguments with the variable argument
handling intrinsic functions. ‘<returntype>
‘ is any type
except label and metadata.
Examples: |
---|
i32 (i32) |
function taking an i32 , returning an i32 |
float (i16, i32 *) * |
Pointer to a function that takes an i16 and a pointer to i32 , returning float . |
i32 (i8*, ...) |
A vararg function that takes at least one pointer to i8 (char in C), which returns an integer. This is the signature for printf in LLVM. |
{i32, i32} (i32) |
A function taking an i32 , returning a structure containing two i32 values |
First Class Types¶
The first class types are perhaps the most important. Values of these types are the only ones which can be produced by instructions.
Single Value Types¶
These are the types that are valid in registers from CodeGen’s perspective.
Integer Type¶
Overview: |
---|
The integer type is a very simple type that simply specifies an arbitrary bit width for the integer type desired. Any bit width from 1 bit to 223-1 (about 8 million) can be specified.
Syntax: |
---|
iN
The number of bits the integer will occupy is specified by the N
value.
Examples:¶
i1 |
a single-bit integer. |
i32 |
a 32-bit integer. |
i1942652 |
a really big integer of over 1 million bits. |
Floating Point Types¶
Type | Description |
---|---|
half |
16-bit floating point value |
float |
32-bit floating point value |
double |
64-bit floating point value |
fp128 |
128-bit floating point value (112-bit mantissa) |
x86_fp80 |
80-bit floating point value (X87) |
ppc_fp128 |
128-bit floating point value (two 64-bits) |
X86_mmx Type¶
Overview: |
---|
The x86_mmx type represents a value held in an MMX register on an x86 machine. The operations allowed on it are quite limited: parameters and return values, load and store, and bitcast. User-specified MMX instructions are represented as intrinsic or asm calls with arguments and/or results of this type. There are no arrays, vectors or constants of this type.
Syntax: |
---|
x86_mmx
Pointer Type¶
Overview: |
---|
The pointer type is used to specify memory locations. Pointers are commonly used to reference objects in memory.
Pointer types may have an optional address space attribute defining the numbered address space where the pointed-to object resides. The default address space is number zero. The semantics of non-zero address spaces are target-specific.
Note that LLVM does not permit pointers to void (void*
) nor does it
permit pointers to labels (label*
). Use i8*
instead.
Syntax: |
---|
<type> *
Examples: |
---|
[4 x i32]* |
A pointer to array of four i32 values. |
i32 (i32*) * |
A pointer to a function that takes an i32* , returning an i32 . |
i32 addrspace(5)* |
A pointer to an i32 value that resides in address space #5. |
Vector Type¶
Overview: |
---|
A vector type is a simple derived type that represents a vector of elements. Vector types are used when multiple primitive data are operated in parallel using a single instruction (SIMD). A vector type requires a size (number of elements) and an underlying primitive data type. Vector types are considered first class.
Syntax: |
---|
< <# elements> x <elementtype> >
The number of elements is a constant integer value larger than 0; elementtype may be any integer, floating point or pointer type. Vectors of size zero are not allowed.
Examples: |
---|
<4 x i32> |
Vector of 4 32-bit integer values. |
<8 x float> |
Vector of 8 32-bit floating-point values. |
<2 x i64> |
Vector of 2 64-bit integer values. |
<4 x i64*> |
Vector of 4 pointers to 64-bit integer values. |
Token Type¶
Overview: |
---|
The token type is used when a value is associated with an instruction but all uses of the value must not attempt to introspect or obscure it. As such, it is not appropriate to have a phi or select of type token.
Syntax: |
---|
token
Metadata Type¶
Overview: |
---|
The metadata type represents embedded metadata. No derived types may be created from metadata except for function arguments.
Syntax: |
---|
metadata
Aggregate Types¶
Aggregate Types are a subset of derived types that can contain multiple member types. Arrays and structs are aggregate types. Vectors are not considered to be aggregate types.
Array Type¶
Overview: |
---|
The array type is a very simple derived type that arranges elements sequentially in memory. The array type requires a size (number of elements) and an underlying data type.
Syntax: |
---|
[<# elements> x <elementtype>]
The number of elements is a constant integer value; elementtype
may
be any type with a size.
Examples: |
---|
[40 x i32] |
Array of 40 32-bit integer values. |
[41 x i32] |
Array of 41 32-bit integer values. |
[4 x i8] |
Array of 4 8-bit integer values. |
Here are some examples of multidimensional arrays:
[3 x [4 x i32]] |
3x4 array of 32-bit integer values. |
[12 x [10 x float]] |
12x10 array of single precision floating point values. |
[2 x [3 x [4 x i16]]] |
2x3x4 array of 16-bit integer values. |
There is no restriction on indexing beyond the end of the array implied
by a static type (though there are restrictions on indexing beyond the
bounds of an allocated object in some cases). This means that
single-dimension ‘variable sized array’ addressing can be implemented in
LLVM with a zero length array type. An implementation of ‘pascal style
arrays’ in LLVM could use the type “{ i32, [0 x float]}
”, for
example.
Structure Type¶
Overview: |
---|
The structure type is used to represent a collection of data members together in memory. The elements of a structure may be any type that has a size.
Structures in memory are accessed using ‘load
‘ and ‘store
‘ by
getting a pointer to a field with the ‘getelementptr
‘ instruction.
Structures in registers are accessed using the ‘extractvalue
‘ and
‘insertvalue
‘ instructions.
Structures may optionally be “packed” structures, which indicate that the alignment of the struct is one byte, and that there is no padding between the elements. In non-packed structs, padding between field types is inserted as defined by the DataLayout string in the module, which is required to match what the underlying code generator expects.
Structures can either be “literal” or “identified”. A literal structure
is defined inline with other types (e.g. {i32, i32}*
) whereas
identified types are always defined at the top level with a name.
Literal types are uniqued by their contents and can never be recursive
or opaque since there is no way to write one. Identified types can be
recursive, can be opaqued, and are never uniqued.
Syntax: |
---|
%T1 = type { <type list> } ; Identified normal struct type
%T2 = type <{ <type list> }> ; Identified packed struct type
Examples: |
---|
{ i32, i32, i32 } |
A triple of three i32 values |
{ float, i32 (i32) * } |
A pair, where the first element is a float and the second element is a pointer to a function that takes an i32 , returning an i32 . |
<{ i8, i32 }> |
A packed struct known to be 5 bytes in size. |
Opaque Structure Types¶
Overview: |
---|
Opaque structure types are used to represent named structure types that do not have a body specified. This corresponds (for example) to the C notion of a forward declared structure.
Syntax: |
---|
%X = type opaque
%52 = type opaque
Examples: |
---|
opaque |
An opaque type. |
Constants¶
LLVM has several different basic types of constants. This section describes them all and their syntax.
Simple Constants¶
- Boolean constants
- The two strings ‘
true
‘ and ‘false
‘ are both valid constants of thei1
type. - Integer constants
- Standard integers (such as ‘4’) are constants of the integer type. Negative numbers may be used with integer types.
- Floating point constants
- Floating point constants use standard decimal notation (e.g. 123.421), exponential notation (e.g. 1.23421e+2), or a more precise hexadecimal notation (see below). The assembler requires the exact decimal value of a floating-point constant. For example, the assembler accepts 1.25 but rejects 1.3 because 1.3 is a repeating decimal in binary. Floating point constants must have a floating point type.
- Null pointer constants
- The identifier ‘
null
‘ is recognized as a null pointer constant and must be of pointer type. - Token constants
- The identifier ‘
none
‘ is recognized as an empty token constant and must be of token type.
The one non-intuitive notation for constants is the hexadecimal form of
floating point constants. For example, the form
‘double 0x432ff973cafa8000
‘ is equivalent to (but harder to read
than) ‘double 4.5e+15
‘. The only time hexadecimal floating point
constants are required (and the only time that they are generated by the
disassembler) is when a floating point constant must be emitted but it
cannot be represented as a decimal floating point number in a reasonable
number of digits. For example, NaN’s, infinities, and other special
values are represented in their IEEE hexadecimal format so that assembly
and disassembly do not cause any bits to change in the constants.
When using the hexadecimal form, constants of types half, float, and
double are represented using the 16-digit form shown above (which
matches the IEEE754 representation for double); half and float values
must, however, be exactly representable as IEEE 754 half and single
precision, respectively. Hexadecimal format is always used for long
double, and there are three forms of long double. The 80-bit format used
by x86 is represented as 0xK
followed by 20 hexadecimal digits. The
128-bit format used by PowerPC (two adjacent doubles) is represented by
0xM
followed by 32 hexadecimal digits. The IEEE 128-bit format is
represented by 0xL
followed by 32 hexadecimal digits. Long doubles
will only work if they match the long double format on your target.
The IEEE 16-bit format (half precision) is represented by 0xH
followed by 4 hexadecimal digits. All hexadecimal formats are big-endian
(sign bit at the left).
There are no constants of type x86_mmx.
Complex Constants¶
Complex constants are a (potentially recursive) combination of simple constants and smaller complex constants.
- Structure constants
- Structure constants are represented with notation similar to
structure type definitions (a comma separated list of elements,
surrounded by braces (
{}
)). For example: “{ i32 4, float 17.0, i32* @G }
”, where “@G
” is declared as “@G = external global i32
”. Structure constants must have structure type, and the number and types of elements must match those specified by the type. - Array constants
- Array constants are represented with notation similar to array type
definitions (a comma separated list of elements, surrounded by
square brackets (
[]
)). For example: “[ i32 42, i32 11, i32 74 ]
”. Array constants must have array type, and the number and types of elements must match those specified by the type. As a special case, character array constants may also be represented as a double-quoted string using thec
prefix. For example: “c"Hello World\0A\00"
”. - Vector constants
- Vector constants are represented with notation similar to vector
type definitions (a comma separated list of elements, surrounded by
less-than/greater-than’s (
<>
)). For example: “< i32 42, i32 11, i32 74, i32 100 >
”. Vector constants must have vector type, and the number and types of elements must match those specified by the type. - Zero initialization
- The string ‘
zeroinitializer
‘ can be used to zero initialize a value to zero of any type, including scalar and aggregate types. This is often used to avoid having to print large zero initializers (e.g. for large arrays) and is always exactly equivalent to using explicit zero initializers. - Metadata node
- A metadata node is a constant tuple without types. For example:
“
!{!0, !{!2, !0}, !"test"}
”. Metadata can reference constant values, for example: “!{!0, i32 0, i8* @global, i64 (i64)* @function, !"str"}
”. Unlike other typed constants that are meant to be interpreted as part of the instruction stream, metadata is a place to attach additional information such as debug info.
Global Variable and Function Addresses¶
The addresses of global variables and functions are always implicitly valid (link-time) constants. These constants are explicitly referenced when the identifier for the global is used and always have pointer type. For example, the following is a legal LLVM file:
@X = global i32 17
@Y = global i32 42
@Z = global [2 x i32*] [ i32* @X, i32* @Y ]
Undefined Values¶
The string ‘undef
‘ can be used anywhere a constant is expected, and
indicates that the user of the value may receive an unspecified
bit-pattern. Undefined values may be of any type (other than ‘label
‘
or ‘void
‘) and be used anywhere a constant is permitted.
Undefined values are useful because they indicate to the compiler that the program is well defined no matter what value is used. This gives the compiler more freedom to optimize. Here are some examples of (potentially surprising) transformations that are valid (in pseudo IR):
%A = add %X, undef
%B = sub %X, undef
%C = xor %X, undef
Safe:
%A = undef
%B = undef
%C = undef
This is safe because all of the output bits are affected by the undef bits. Any output bit can have a zero or one depending on the input bits.
%A = or %X, undef
%B = and %X, undef
Safe:
%A = -1
%B = 0
Unsafe:
%A = undef
%B = undef
These logical operations have bits that are not always affected by the
input. For example, if %X
has a zero bit, then the output of the
‘and
‘ operation will always be a zero for that bit, no matter what
the corresponding bit from the ‘undef
‘ is. As such, it is unsafe to
optimize or assume that the result of the ‘and
‘ is ‘undef
‘.
However, it is safe to assume that all bits of the ‘undef
‘ could be
0, and optimize the ‘and
‘ to 0. Likewise, it is safe to assume that
all the bits of the ‘undef
‘ operand to the ‘or
‘ could be set,
allowing the ‘or
‘ to be folded to -1.
%A = select undef, %X, %Y
%B = select undef, 42, %Y
%C = select %X, %Y, undef
Safe:
%A = %X (or %Y)
%B = 42 (or %Y)
%C = %Y
Unsafe:
%A = undef
%B = undef
%C = undef
This set of examples shows that undefined ‘select
‘ (and conditional
branch) conditions can go either way, but they have to come from one
of the two operands. In the %A
example, if %X
and %Y
were
both known to have a clear low bit, then %A
would have to have a
cleared low bit. However, in the %C
example, the optimizer is
allowed to assume that the ‘undef
‘ operand could be the same as
%Y
, allowing the whole ‘select
‘ to be eliminated.
%A = xor undef, undef
%B = undef
%C = xor %B, %B
%D = undef
%E = icmp slt %D, 4
%F = icmp gte %D, 4
Safe:
%A = undef
%B = undef
%C = undef
%D = undef
%E = undef
%F = undef
This example points out that two ‘undef
‘ operands are not
necessarily the same. This can be surprising to people (and also matches
C semantics) where they assume that “X^X
” is always zero, even if
X
is undefined. This isn’t true for a number of reasons, but the
short answer is that an ‘undef
‘ “variable” can arbitrarily change
its value over its “live range”. This is true because the variable
doesn’t actually have a live range. Instead, the value is logically
read from arbitrary registers that happen to be around when needed, so
the value is not necessarily consistent over time. In fact, %A
and
%C
need to have the same semantics or the core LLVM “replace all
uses with” concept would not hold.
%A = fdiv undef, %X
%B = fdiv %X, undef
Safe:
%A = undef
b: unreachable
These examples show the crucial difference between an undefined value
and undefined behavior. An undefined value (like ‘undef
‘) is
allowed to have an arbitrary bit-pattern. This means that the %A
operation can be constant folded to ‘undef
‘, because the ‘undef
‘
could be an SNaN, and fdiv
is not (currently) defined on SNaN’s.
However, in the second example, we can make a more aggressive
assumption: because the undef
is allowed to be an arbitrary value,
we are allowed to assume that it could be zero. Since a divide by zero
has undefined behavior, we are allowed to assume that the operation
does not execute at all. This allows us to delete the divide and all
code after it. Because the undefined operation “can’t happen”, the
optimizer can assume that it occurs in dead code.
a: store undef -> %X
b: store %X -> undef
Safe:
a: <deleted>
b: unreachable
These examples reiterate the fdiv
example: a store of an undefined
value can be assumed to not have any effect; we can assume that the
value is overwritten with bits that happen to match what was already
there. However, a store to an undefined location could clobber
arbitrary memory, therefore, it has undefined behavior.
Poison Values¶
Poison values are similar to undef values, however they also represent the fact that an instruction or constant expression that cannot evoke side effects has nevertheless detected a condition that results in undefined behavior.
There is currently no way of representing a poison value in the IR; they
only exist when produced by operations such as add with
the nsw
flag.
Poison value behavior is defined in terms of value dependence:
- Values other than phi nodes depend on their operands.
- Phi nodes depend on the operand corresponding to their dynamic predecessor basic block.
- Function arguments depend on the corresponding actual argument values in the dynamic callers of their functions.
- Call instructions depend on the ret instructions that dynamically transfer control back to them.
- Invoke instructions depend on the ret, resume, or exception-throwing call instructions that dynamically transfer control back to them.
- Non-volatile loads and stores depend on the most recent stores to all of the referenced memory addresses, following the order in the IR (including loads and stores implied by intrinsics such as @llvm.memcpy.)
- An instruction with externally visible side effects depends on the most recent preceding instruction with externally visible side effects, following the order in the IR. (This includes volatile operations.)
- An instruction control-depends on a terminator instruction if the terminator instruction has multiple successors and the instruction is always executed when control transfers to one of the successors, and may not be executed when control is transferred to another.
- Additionally, an instruction also control-depends on a terminator instruction if the set of instructions it otherwise depends on would be different if the terminator had transferred control to a different successor.
- Dependence is transitive.
Poison values have the same behavior as undef values, with the additional effect that any instruction that has a dependence on a poison value has undefined behavior.
Here are some examples:
entry:
%poison = sub nuw i32 0, 1 ; Results in a poison value.
%still_poison = and i32 %poison, 0 ; 0, but also poison.
%poison_yet_again = getelementptr i32, i32* @h, i32 %still_poison
store i32 0, i32* %poison_yet_again ; memory at @h[0] is poisoned
store i32 %poison, i32* @g ; Poison value stored to memory.
%poison2 = load i32, i32* @g ; Poison value loaded back from memory.
store volatile i32 %poison, i32* @g ; External observation; undefined behavior.
%narrowaddr = bitcast i32* @g to i16*
%wideaddr = bitcast i32* @g to i64*
%poison3 = load i16, i16* %narrowaddr ; Returns a poison value.
%poison4 = load i64, i64* %wideaddr ; Returns a poison value.
%cmp = icmp slt i32 %poison, 0 ; Returns a poison value.
br i1 %cmp, label %true, label %end ; Branch to either destination.
true:
store volatile i32 0, i32* @g ; This is control-dependent on %cmp, so
; it has undefined behavior.
br label %end
end:
%p = phi i32 [ 0, %entry ], [ 1, %true ]
; Both edges into this PHI are
; control-dependent on %cmp, so this
; always results in a poison value.
store volatile i32 0, i32* @g ; This would depend on the store in %true
; if %cmp is true, or the store in %entry
; otherwise, so this is undefined behavior.
br i1 %cmp, label %second_true, label %second_end
; The same branch again, but this time the
; true block doesn't have side effects.
second_true:
; No side effects!
ret void
second_end:
store volatile i32 0, i32* @g ; This time, the instruction always depends
; on the store in %end. Also, it is
; control-equivalent to %end, so this is
; well-defined (ignoring earlier undefined
; behavior in this example).
Addresses of Basic Blocks¶
blockaddress(@function, %block)
The ‘blockaddress
‘ constant computes the address of the specified
basic block in the specified function, and always has an i8*
type.
Taking the address of the entry block is illegal.
This value only has defined behavior when used as an operand to the
‘indirectbr‘ instruction, or for comparisons
against null. Pointer equality tests between labels addresses results in
undefined behavior — though, again, comparison against null is ok, and
no label is equal to the null pointer. This may be passed around as an
opaque pointer sized value as long as the bits are not inspected. This
allows ptrtoint
and arithmetic to be performed on these values so
long as the original value is reconstituted before the indirectbr
instruction.
Finally, some targets may provide defined semantics when using the value as the operand to an inline assembly, but that is target specific.
Constant Expressions¶
Constant expressions are used to allow expressions involving other constants to be used as constants. Constant expressions may be of any first class type and may involve any LLVM operation that does not have side effects (e.g. load and call are not supported). The following is the syntax for constant expressions:
trunc (CST to TYPE)
- Truncate a constant to another type. The bit size of CST must be larger than the bit size of TYPE. Both types must be integers.
zext (CST to TYPE)
- Zero extend a constant to another type. The bit size of CST must be smaller than the bit size of TYPE. Both types must be integers.
sext (CST to TYPE)
- Sign extend a constant to another type. The bit size of CST must be smaller than the bit size of TYPE. Both types must be integers.
fptrunc (CST to TYPE)
- Truncate a floating point constant to another floating point type. The size of CST must be larger than the size of TYPE. Both types must be floating point.
fpext (CST to TYPE)
- Floating point extend a constant to another type. The size of CST must be smaller or equal to the size of TYPE. Both types must be floating point.
fptoui (CST to TYPE)
- Convert a floating point constant to the corresponding unsigned integer constant. TYPE must be a scalar or vector integer type. CST must be of scalar or vector floating point type. Both CST and TYPE must be scalars, or vectors of the same number of elements. If the value won’t fit in the integer type, the results are undefined.
fptosi (CST to TYPE)
- Convert a floating point constant to the corresponding signed integer constant. TYPE must be a scalar or vector integer type. CST must be of scalar or vector floating point type. Both CST and TYPE must be scalars, or vectors of the same number of elements. If the value won’t fit in the integer type, the results are undefined.
uitofp (CST to TYPE)
- Convert an unsigned integer constant to the corresponding floating point constant. TYPE must be a scalar or vector floating point type. CST must be of scalar or vector integer type. Both CST and TYPE must be scalars, or vectors of the same number of elements. If the value won’t fit in the floating point type, the results are undefined.
sitofp (CST to TYPE)
- Convert a signed integer constant to the corresponding floating point constant. TYPE must be a scalar or vector floating point type. CST must be of scalar or vector integer type. Both CST and TYPE must be scalars, or vectors of the same number of elements. If the value won’t fit in the floating point type, the results are undefined.
ptrtoint (CST to TYPE)
- Convert a pointer typed constant to the corresponding integer
constant.
TYPE
must be an integer type.CST
must be of pointer type. TheCST
value is zero extended, truncated, or unchanged to make it fit inTYPE
. inttoptr (CST to TYPE)
- Convert an integer constant to a pointer constant. TYPE must be a pointer type. CST must be of integer type. The CST value is zero extended, truncated, or unchanged to make it fit in a pointer size. This one is really dangerous!
bitcast (CST to TYPE)
- Convert a constant, CST, to another TYPE. The constraints of the operands are the same as those for the bitcast instruction.
addrspacecast (CST to TYPE)
- Convert a constant pointer or constant vector of pointer, CST, to another TYPE in a different address space. The constraints of the operands are the same as those for the addrspacecast instruction.
getelementptr (TY, CSTPTR, IDX0, IDX1, ...)
,getelementptr inbounds (TY, CSTPTR, IDX0, IDX1, ...)
- Perform the getelementptr operation on constants. As with the getelementptr instruction, the index list may have zero or more indexes, which are required to make sense for the type of “pointer to TY”.
select (COND, VAL1, VAL2)
- Perform the select operation on constants.
icmp COND (VAL1, VAL2)
- Performs the icmp operation on constants.
fcmp COND (VAL1, VAL2)
- Performs the fcmp operation on constants.
extractelement (VAL, IDX)
- Perform the extractelement operation on constants.
insertelement (VAL, ELT, IDX)
- Perform the insertelement operation on constants.
shufflevector (VEC1, VEC2, IDXMASK)
- Perform the shufflevector operation on constants.
extractvalue (VAL, IDX0, IDX1, ...)
- Perform the extractvalue operation on constants. The index list is interpreted in a similar manner as indices in a ‘getelementptr‘ operation. At least one index value must be specified.
insertvalue (VAL, ELT, IDX0, IDX1, ...)
- Perform the insertvalue operation on constants. The index list is interpreted in a similar manner as indices in a ‘getelementptr‘ operation. At least one index value must be specified.
OPCODE (LHS, RHS)
- Perform the specified operation of the LHS and RHS constants. OPCODE may be any of the binary or bitwise binary operations. The constraints on operands are the same as those for the corresponding instruction (e.g. no bitwise operations on floating point values are allowed).
Other Values¶
Inline Assembler Expressions¶
LLVM supports inline assembler expressions (as opposed to Module-Level Inline Assembly) through the use of a special value. This value represents the inline assembler as a template string (containing the instructions to emit), a list of operand constraints (stored as a string), a flag that indicates whether or not the inline asm expression has side effects, and a flag indicating whether the function containing the asm needs to align its stack conservatively.
The template string supports argument substitution of the operands using “$
”
followed by a number, to indicate substitution of the given register/memory
location, as specified by the constraint string. “${NUM:MODIFIER}
” may also
be used, where MODIFIER
is a target-specific annotation for how to print the
operand (See Asm template argument modifiers).
A literal “$
” may be included by using “$$
” in the template. To include
other special characters into the output, the usual “\XX
” escapes may be
used, just as in other strings. Note that after template substitution, the
resulting assembly string is parsed by LLVM’s integrated assembler unless it is
disabled – even when emitting a .s
file – and thus must contain assembly
syntax known to LLVM.
LLVM’s support for inline asm is modeled closely on the requirements of Clang’s GCC-compatible inline-asm support. Thus, the feature-set and the constraint and modifier codes listed here are similar or identical to those in GCC’s inline asm support. However, to be clear, the syntax of the template and constraint strings described here is not the same as the syntax accepted by GCC and Clang, and, while most constraint letters are passed through as-is by Clang, some get translated to other codes when converting from the C source to the LLVM assembly.
An example inline assembler expression is:
i32 (i32) asm "bswap $0", "=r,r"
Inline assembler expressions may only be used as the callee operand of a call or an invoke instruction. Thus, typically we have:
%X = call i32 asm "bswap $0", "=r,r"(i32 %Y)
Inline asms with side effects not visible in the constraint list must be
marked as having side effects. This is done through the use of the
‘sideeffect
‘ keyword, like so:
call void asm sideeffect "eieio", ""()
In some cases inline asms will contain code that will not work unless
the stack is aligned in some way, such as calls or SSE instructions on
x86, yet will not contain code that does that alignment within the asm.
The compiler should make conservative assumptions about what the asm
might contain and should generate its usual stack alignment code in the
prologue if the ‘alignstack
‘ keyword is present:
call void asm alignstack "eieio", ""()
Inline asms also support using non-standard assembly dialects. The
assumed dialect is ATT. When the ‘inteldialect
‘ keyword is present,
the inline asm is using the Intel dialect. Currently, ATT and Intel are
the only supported dialects. An example is:
call void asm inteldialect "eieio", ""()
If multiple keywords appear the ‘sideeffect
‘ keyword must come
first, the ‘alignstack
‘ keyword second and the ‘inteldialect
‘
keyword last.
Inline Asm Constraint String¶
The constraint list is a comma-separated string, each element containing one or more constraint codes.
For each element in the constraint list an appropriate register or memory
operand will be chosen, and it will be made available to assembly template
string expansion as $0
for the first constraint in the list, $1
for the
second, etc.
There are three different types of constraints, which are distinguished by a prefix symbol in front of the constraint code: Output, Input, and Clobber. The constraints must always be given in that order: outputs first, then inputs, then clobbers. They cannot be intermingled.
There are also three different categories of constraint codes:
- Register constraint. This is either a register class, or a fixed physical register. This kind of constraint will allocate a register, and if necessary, bitcast the argument or result to the appropriate type.
- Memory constraint. This kind of constraint is for use with an instruction taking a memory operand. Different constraints allow for different addressing modes used by the target.
- Immediate value constraint. This kind of constraint is for an integer or other immediate value which can be rendered directly into an instruction. The various target-specific constraints allow the selection of a value in the proper range for the instruction you wish to use it with.
Output constraints¶
Output constraints are specified by an “=
” prefix (e.g. “=r
”). This
indicates that the assembly will write to this operand, and the operand will
then be made available as a return value of the asm
expression. Output
constraints do not consume an argument from the call instruction. (Except, see
below about indirect outputs).
Normally, it is expected that no output locations are written to by the assembly
expression until all of the inputs have been read. As such, LLVM may assign
the same register to an output and an input. If this is not safe (e.g. if the
assembly contains two instructions, where the first writes to one output, and
the second reads an input and writes to a second output), then the “&
”
modifier must be used (e.g. “=&r
”) to specify that the output is an
“early-clobber” output. Marking an output as “early-clobber” ensures that LLVM
will not use the same register for any inputs (other than an input tied to this
output).
Input constraints¶
Input constraints do not have a prefix – just the constraint codes. Each input constraint will consume one argument from the call instruction. It is not permitted for the asm to write to any input register or memory location (unless that input is tied to an output). Note also that multiple inputs may all be assigned to the same register, if LLVM can determine that they necessarily all contain the same value.
Instead of providing a Constraint Code, input constraints may also “tie”
themselves to an output constraint, by providing an integer as the constraint
string. Tied inputs still consume an argument from the call instruction, and
take up a position in the asm template numbering as is usual – they will simply
be constrained to always use the same register as the output they’ve been tied
to. For example, a constraint string of “=r,0
” says to assign a register for
output, and use that register as an input as well (it being the 0’th
constraint).
It is permitted to tie an input to an “early-clobber” output. In that case, no other input may share the same register as the input tied to the early-clobber (even when the other input has the same value).
You may only tie an input to an output which has a register constraint, not a memory constraint. Only a single input may be tied to an output.
There is also an “interesting” feature which deserves a bit of explanation: if a register class constraint allocates a register which is too small for the value type operand provided as input, the input value will be split into multiple registers, and all of them passed to the inline asm.
However, this feature is often not as useful as you might think.
Firstly, the registers are not guaranteed to be consecutive. So, on those architectures that have instructions which operate on multiple consecutive instructions, this is not an appropriate way to support them. (e.g. the 32-bit SparcV8 has a 64-bit load, which instruction takes a single 32-bit register. The hardware then loads into both the named register, and the next register. This feature of inline asm would not be useful to support that.)
A few of the targets provide a template string modifier allowing explicit access
to the second register of a two-register operand (e.g. MIPS L
, M
, and
D
). On such an architecture, you can actually access the second allocated
register (yet, still, not any subsequent ones). But, in that case, you’re still
probably better off simply splitting the value into two separate operands, for
clarity. (e.g. see the description of the A
constraint on X86, which,
despite existing only for use with this feature, is not really a good idea to
use)
Indirect inputs and outputs¶
Indirect output or input constraints can be specified by the “*
” modifier
(which goes after the “=
” in case of an output). This indicates that the asm
will write to or read from the contents of an address provided as an input
argument. (Note that in this way, indirect outputs act more like an input than
an output: just like an input, they consume an argument of the call expression,
rather than producing a return value. An indirect output constraint is an
“output” only in that the asm is expected to write to the contents of the input
memory location, instead of just read from it).
This is most typically used for memory constraint, e.g. “=*m
”, to pass the
address of a variable as a value.
It is also possible to use an indirect register constraint, but only on output
(e.g. “=*r
”). This will cause LLVM to allocate a register for an output
value normally, and then, separately emit a store to the address provided as
input, after the provided inline asm. (It’s not clear what value this
functionality provides, compared to writing the store explicitly after the asm
statement, and it can only produce worse code, since it bypasses many
optimization passes. I would recommend not using it.)
Clobber constraints¶
A clobber constraint is indicated by a “~
” prefix. A clobber does not
consume an input operand, nor generate an output. Clobbers cannot use any of the
general constraint code letters – they may use only explicit register
constraints, e.g. “~{eax}
”. The one exception is that a clobber string of
“~{memory}
” indicates that the assembly writes to arbitrary undeclared
memory locations – not only the memory pointed to by a declared indirect
output.
Constraint Codes¶
After a potential prefix comes constraint code, or codes.
A Constraint Code is either a single letter (e.g. “r
”), a “^
” character
followed by two letters (e.g. “^wc
”), or “{
” register-name “}
”
(e.g. “{eax}
”).
The one and two letter constraint codes are typically chosen to be the same as GCC’s constraint codes.
A single constraint may include one or more than constraint code in it, leaving it up to LLVM to choose which one to use. This is included mainly for compatibility with the translation of GCC inline asm coming from clang.
There are two ways to specify alternatives, and either or both may be used in an inline asm constraint list:
- Append the codes to each other, making a constraint code set. E.g. “
im
” or “{eax}m
”. This means “choose any of the options in the set”. The choice of constraint is made independently for each constraint in the constraint list. - Use “
|
” between constraint code sets, creating alternatives. Every constraint in the constraint list must have the same number of alternative sets. With this syntax, the same alternative in all of the items in the constraint list will be chosen together.
Putting those together, you might have a two operand constraint string like
"rm|r,ri|rm"
. This indicates that if operand 0 is r
or m
, then
operand 1 may be one of r
or i
. If operand 0 is r
, then operand 1
may be one of r
or m
. But, operand 0 and 1 cannot both be of type m.
However, the use of either of the alternatives features is NOT recommended, as
LLVM is not able to make an intelligent choice about which one to use. (At the
point it currently needs to choose, not enough information is available to do so
in a smart way.) Thus, it simply tries to make a choice that’s most likely to
compile, not one that will be optimal performance. (e.g., given “rm
”, it’ll
always choose to use memory, not registers). And, if given multiple registers,
or multiple register classes, it will simply choose the first one. (In fact, it
doesn’t currently even ensure explicitly specified physical registers are
unique, so specifying multiple physical registers as alternatives, like
{r11}{r12},{r11}{r12}
, will assign r11 to both operands, not at all what was
intended.)
Supported Constraint Code List¶
The constraint codes are, in general, expected to behave the same way they do in GCC. LLVM’s support is often implemented on an ‘as-needed’ basis, to support C inline asm code which was supported by GCC. A mismatch in behavior between LLVM and GCC likely indicates a bug in LLVM.
Some constraint codes are typically supported by all targets:
r
: A register in the target’s general purpose register class.m
: A memory address operand. It is target-specific what addressing modes are supported, typical examples are register, or register + register offset, or register + immediate offset (of some target-specific size).i
: An integer constant (of target-specific width). Allows either a simple immediate, or a relocatable value.n
: An integer constant – not including relocatable values.s
: An integer constant, but allowing only relocatable values.X
: Allows an operand of any kind, no constraint whatsoever. Typically useful to pass a label for an asm branch or call.{register-name}
: Requires exactly the named physical register.
Other constraints are target-specific:
AArch64:
z
: An immediate integer 0. OutputsWZR
orXZR
, as appropriate.I
: An immediate integer valid for anADD
orSUB
instruction, i.e. 0 to 4095 with optional shift by 12.J
: An immediate integer that, when negated, is valid for anADD
orSUB
instruction, i.e. -1 to -4095 with optional left shift by 12.K
: An immediate integer that is valid for the ‘bitmask immediate 32’ of a logical instruction likeAND
,EOR
, orORR
with a 32-bit register.L
: An immediate integer that is valid for the ‘bitmask immediate 64’ of a logical instruction likeAND
,EOR
, orORR
with a 64-bit register.M
: An immediate integer for use with theMOV
assembly alias on a 32-bit register. This is a superset ofK
: in addition to the bitmask immediate, also allows immediate integers which can be loaded with a singleMOVZ
orMOVL
instruction.N
: An immediate integer for use with theMOV
assembly alias on a 64-bit register. This is a superset ofL
.Q
: Memory address operand must be in a single register (no offsets). (However, LLVM currently does this for them
constraint as well.)r
: A 32 or 64-bit integer register (W* or X*).w
: A 32, 64, or 128-bit floating-point/SIMD register.x
: A lower 128-bit floating-point/SIMD register (V0
toV15
).
AMDGPU:
r
: A 32 or 64-bit integer register.[0-9]v
: The 32-bit VGPR register, number 0-9.[0-9]s
: The 32-bit SGPR register, number 0-9.
All ARM modes:
Q
,Um
,Un
,Uq
,Us
,Ut
,Uv
,Uy
: Memory address operand. Treated the same as operandm
, at the moment.
ARM and ARM’s Thumb2 mode:
j
: An immediate integer between 0 and 65535 (valid forMOVW
)I
: An immediate integer valid for a data-processing instruction.J
: An immediate integer between -4095 and 4095.K
: An immediate integer whose bitwise inverse is valid for a data-processing instruction. (Can be used with template modifier “B
” to print the inverted value).L
: An immediate integer whose negation is valid for a data-processing instruction. (Can be used with template modifier “n
” to print the negated value).M
: A power of two or a integer between 0 and 32.N
: Invalid immediate constraint.O
: Invalid immediate constraint.r
: A general-purpose 32-bit integer register (r0-r15
).l
: In Thumb2 mode, low 32-bit GPR registers (r0-r7
). In ARM mode, same asr
.h
: In Thumb2 mode, a high 32-bit GPR register (r8-r15
). In ARM mode, invalid.w
: A 32, 64, or 128-bit floating-point/SIMD register:s0-s31
,d0-d31
, orq0-q15
.x
: A 32, 64, or 128-bit floating-point/SIMD register:s0-s15
,d0-d7
, orq0-q3
.t
: A floating-point/SIMD register, only supports 32-bit values:s0-s31
.
ARM’s Thumb1 mode:
I
: An immediate integer between 0 and 255.J
: An immediate integer between -255 and -1.K
: An immediate integer between 0 and 255, with optional left-shift by some amount.L
: An immediate integer between -7 and 7.M
: An immediate integer which is a multiple of 4 between 0 and 1020.N
: An immediate integer between 0 and 31.O
: An immediate integer which is a multiple of 4 between -508 and 508.r
: A low 32-bit GPR register (r0-r7
).l
: A low 32-bit GPR register (r0-r7
).h
: A high GPR register (r0-r7
).w
: A 32, 64, or 128-bit floating-point/SIMD register:s0-s31
,d0-d31
, orq0-q15
.x
: A 32, 64, or 128-bit floating-point/SIMD register:s0-s15
,d0-d7
, orq0-q3
.t
: A floating-point/SIMD register, only supports 32-bit values:s0-s31
.
Hexagon:
o
,v
: A memory address operand, treated the same as constraintm
, at the moment.r
: A 32 or 64-bit register.
MSP430:
r
: An 8 or 16-bit register.
MIPS:
I
: An immediate signed 16-bit integer.J
: An immediate integer zero.K
: An immediate unsigned 16-bit integer.L
: An immediate 32-bit integer, where the lower 16 bits are 0.N
: An immediate integer between -65535 and -1.O
: An immediate signed 15-bit integer.P
: An immediate integer between 1 and 65535.m
: A memory address operand. In MIPS-SE mode, allows a base address register plus 16-bit immediate offset. In MIPS mode, just a base register.R
: A memory address operand. In MIPS-SE mode, allows a base address register plus a 9-bit signed offset. In MIPS mode, the same as constraintm
.ZC
: A memory address operand, suitable for use in apref
,ll
, orsc
instruction on the given subtarget (details vary).r
,d
,y
: A 32 or 64-bit GPR register.f
: A 32 or 64-bit FPU register (F0-F31
), or a 128-bit MSA register (W0-W31
). In the case of MSA registers, it is recommended to use thew
argument modifier for compatibility with GCC.c
: A 32-bit or 64-bit GPR register suitable for indirect jump (always25
).l
: Thelo
register, 32 or 64-bit.x
: Invalid.
NVPTX:
b
: A 1-bit integer register.c
orh
: A 16-bit integer register.r
: A 32-bit integer register.l
orN
: A 64-bit integer register.f
: A 32-bit float register.d
: A 64-bit float register.
PowerPC:
I
: An immediate signed 16-bit integer.J
: An immediate unsigned 16-bit integer, shifted left 16 bits.K
: An immediate unsigned 16-bit integer.L
: An immediate signed 16-bit integer, shifted left 16 bits.M
: An immediate integer greater than 31.N
: An immediate integer that is an exact power of 2.O
: The immediate integer constant 0.P
: An immediate integer constant whose negation is a signed 16-bit constant.es
,o
,Q
,Z
,Zy
: A memory address operand, currently treated the same asm
.r
: A 32 or 64-bit integer register.b
: A 32 or 64-bit integer register, excludingR0
(that is:R1-R31
).f
: A 32 or 64-bit float register (F0-F31
), or when QPX is enabled, a 128 or 256-bit QPX register (Q0-Q31
; aliases theF
registers).v
: For4 x f32
or4 x f64
types, when QPX is enabled, a 128 or 256-bit QPX register (Q0-Q31
), otherwise a 128-bit altivec vector register (V0-V31
).y
: Condition register (CR0-CR7
).wc
: An individual CR bit in a CR register.wa
,wd
,wf
: Any 128-bit VSX vector register, from the full VSX register set (overlapping both the floating-point and vector register files).ws
: A 32 or 64-bit floating point register, from the full VSX register set.
Sparc:
I
: An immediate 13-bit signed integer.r
: A 32-bit integer register.
SystemZ:
I
: An immediate unsigned 8-bit integer.J
: An immediate unsigned 12-bit integer.K
: An immediate signed 16-bit integer.L
: An immediate signed 20-bit integer.M
: An immediate integer 0x7fffffff.Q
,R
,S
,T
: A memory address operand, treated the same asm
, at the moment.r
ord
: A 32, 64, or 128-bit integer register.a
: A 32, 64, or 128-bit integer address register (excludes R0, which in an address context evaluates as zero).h
: A 32-bit value in the high part of a 64bit data register (LLVM-specific)f
: A 32, 64, or 128-bit floating point register.
X86:
I
: An immediate integer between 0 and 31.J
: An immediate integer between 0 and 64.K
: An immediate signed 8-bit integer.L
: An immediate integer, 0xff or 0xffff or (in 64-bit mode only) 0xffffffff.M
: An immediate integer between 0 and 3.N
: An immediate unsigned 8-bit integer.O
: An immediate integer between 0 and 127.e
: An immediate 32-bit signed integer.Z
: An immediate 32-bit unsigned integer.o
,v
: Treated the same asm
, at the moment.q
: An 8, 16, 32, or 64-bit register which can be accessed as an 8-bitl
integer register. On X86-32, this is thea
,b
,c
, andd
registers, and on X86-64, it is all of the integer registers.Q
: An 8, 16, 32, or 64-bit register which can be accessed as an 8-bith
integer register. This is thea
,b
,c
, andd
registers.r
orl
: An 8, 16, 32, or 64-bit integer register.R
: An 8, 16, 32, or 64-bit “legacy” integer register – one which has existed since i386, and can be accessed without the REX prefix.f
: A 32, 64, or 80-bit ‘387 FPU stack pseudo-register.y
: A 64-bit MMX register, if MMX is enabled.x
: If SSE is enabled: a 32 or 64-bit scalar operand, or 128-bit vector operand in a SSE register. If AVX is also enabled, can also be a 256-bit vector operand in an AVX register. If AVX-512 is also enabled, can also be a 512-bit vector operand in an AVX512 register, Otherwise, an error.Y
: The same asx
, if SSE2 is enabled, otherwise an error.A
: Special case: allocates EAX first, then EDX, for a single operand (in 32-bit mode, a 64-bit integer operand will get split into two registers). It is not recommended to use this constraint, as in 64-bit mode, the 64-bit operand will get allocated only to RAX – if two 32-bit operands are needed, you’re better off splitting it yourself, before passing it to the asm statement.
XCore:
r
: A 32-bit integer register.
Asm template argument modifiers¶
In the asm template string, modifiers can be used on the operand reference, like
“${0:n}
”.
The modifiers are, in general, expected to behave the same way they do in GCC. LLVM’s support is often implemented on an ‘as-needed’ basis, to support C inline asm code which was supported by GCC. A mismatch in behavior between LLVM and GCC likely indicates a bug in LLVM.
Target-independent:
c
: Print an immediate integer constant unadorned, without the target-specific immediate punctuation (e.g. no$
prefix).n
: Negate and print immediate integer constant unadorned, without the target-specific immediate punctuation (e.g. no$
prefix).l
: Print as an unadorned label, without the target-specific label punctuation (e.g. no$
prefix).
AArch64:
w
: Print a GPR register with aw*
name instead ofx*
name. E.g., instead ofx30
, printw30
.x
: Print a GPR register with ax*
name. (this is the default, anyhow).b
,h
,s
,d
,q
: Print a floating-point/SIMD register with ab*
,h*
,s*
,d*
, orq*
name, rather than the default ofv*
.
AMDGPU:
r
: No effect.
ARM:
a
: Print an operand as an address (with[
and]
surrounding a register).P
: No effect.q
: No effect.y
: Print a VFP single-precision register as an indexed double (e.g. print asd4[1]
instead ofs9
)B
: Bitwise invert and print an immediate integer constant without#
prefix.L
: Print the low 16-bits of an immediate integer constant.M
: Print as a register set suitable for ldm/stm. Also prints all register operands subsequent to the specified one (!), so use carefully.Q
: Print the low-order register of a register-pair, or the low-order register of a two-register operand.R
: Print the high-order register of a register-pair, or the high-order register of a two-register operand.H
: Print the second register of a register-pair. (On a big-endian system,H
is equivalent toQ
, and on little-endian system,H
is equivalent toR
.)e
: Print the low doubleword register of a NEON quad register.f
: Print the high doubleword register of a NEON quad register.m
: Print the base register of a memory operand without the[
and]
adornment.
Hexagon:
L
: Print the second register of a two-register operand. Requires that it has been allocated consecutively to the first.I
: Print the letter ‘i’ if the operand is an integer constant, otherwise nothing. Used to print ‘addi’ vs ‘add’ instructions.
MSP430:
No additional modifiers.
MIPS:
X
: Print an immediate integer as hexadecimalx
: Print the low 16 bits of an immediate integer as hexadecimal.d
: Print an immediate integer as decimal.m
: Subtract one and print an immediate integer as decimal.z
: Print $0 if an immediate zero, otherwise print normally.L
: Print the low-order register of a two-register operand, or prints the address of the low-order word of a double-word memory operand.M
: Print the high-order register of a two-register operand, or prints the address of the high-order word of a double-word memory operand.D
: Print the second register of a two-register operand, or prints the second word of a double-word memory operand. (On a big-endian system,D
is equivalent toL
, and on little-endian system,D
is equivalent toM
.)w
: No effect. Provided for compatibility with GCC which requires this modifier in order to print MSA registers (W0-W31
) with thef
constraint.
NVPTX:
r
: No effect.
PowerPC:
L
: Print the second register of a two-register operand. Requires that it has been allocated consecutively to the first.I
: Print the letter ‘i’ if the operand is an integer constant, otherwise nothing. Used to print ‘addi’ vs ‘add’ instructions.y
: For a memory operand, prints formatter for a two-register X-form instruction. (Currently always printsr0,OPERAND
).U
: Prints ‘u’ if the memory operand is an update form, and nothing otherwise. (NOTE: LLVM does not support update form, so this will currently always print nothing)X
: Prints ‘x’ if the memory operand is an indexed form. (NOTE: LLVM does not support indexed form, so this will currently always print nothing)
Sparc:
r
: No effect.
SystemZ:
SystemZ implements only n
, and does not support any of the other
target-independent modifiers.
X86:
c
: Print an unadorned integer or symbol name. (The latter is target-specific behavior for this typically target-independent modifier).A
: Print a register name with a ‘*
‘ before it.b
: Print an 8-bit register name (e.g.al
); do nothing on a memory operand.h
: Print the upper 8-bit register name (e.g.ah
); do nothing on a memory operand.w
: Print the 16-bit register name (e.g.ax
); do nothing on a memory operand.k
: Print the 32-bit register name (e.g.eax
); do nothing on a memory operand.q
: Print the 64-bit register name (e.g.rax
), if 64-bit registers are available, otherwise the 32-bit register name; do nothing on a memory operand.n
: Negate and print an unadorned integer, or, for operands other than an immediate integer (e.g. a relocatable symbol expression), print a ‘-‘ before the operand. (The behavior for relocatable symbol expressions is a target-specific behavior for this typically target-independent modifier)H
: Print a memory reference with additional offset +8.P
: Print a memory reference or operand for use as the argument of a call instruction. (E.g. omit(rip)
, even though it’s PC-relative.)
XCore:
No additional modifiers.
Inline Asm Metadata¶
The call instructions that wrap inline asm nodes may have a
“!srcloc
” MDNode attached to it that contains a list of constant
integers. If present, the code generator will use the integer as the
location cookie value when report errors through the LLVMContext
error reporting mechanisms. This allows a front-end to correlate backend
errors that occur with inline asm back to the source code that produced
it. For example:
call void asm sideeffect "something bad", ""(), !srcloc !42
...
!42 = !{ i32 1234567 }
It is up to the front-end to make sense of the magic numbers it places in the IR. If the MDNode contains multiple constants, the code generator will use the one that corresponds to the line of the asm that the error occurs on.
Metadata¶
LLVM IR allows metadata to be attached to instructions in the program that can convey extra information about the code to the optimizers and code generator. One example application of metadata is source-level debug information. There are two metadata primitives: strings and nodes.
Metadata does not have a type, and is not a value. If referenced from a
call
instruction, it uses the metadata
type.
All metadata are identified in syntax by a exclamation point (‘!
‘).
Metadata Nodes and Metadata Strings¶
A metadata string is a string surrounded by double quotes. It can
contain any character by escaping non-printable characters with
“\xx
” where “xx
” is the two digit hex code. For example:
“!"test\00"
”.
Metadata nodes are represented with notation similar to structure constants (a comma separated list of elements, surrounded by braces and preceded by an exclamation point). Metadata nodes can have any values as their operand. For example:
!{ !"test\00", i32 10}
Metadata nodes that aren’t uniqued use the distinct
keyword. For example:
!0 = distinct !{!"test\00", i32 10}
distinct
nodes are useful when nodes shouldn’t be merged based on their
content. They can also occur when transformations cause uniquing collisions
when metadata operands change.
A named metadata is a collection of metadata nodes, which can be looked up in the module symbol table. For example:
!foo = !{!4, !3}
Metadata can be used as function arguments. Here llvm.dbg.value
function is using two metadata arguments:
call void @llvm.dbg.value(metadata !24, i64 0, metadata !25)
Metadata can be attached to an instruction. Here metadata !21
is attached
to the add
instruction using the !dbg
identifier:
%indvar.next = add i64 %indvar, 1, !dbg !21
Metadata can also be attached to a function definition. Here metadata !22
is attached to the foo
function using the !dbg
identifier:
define void @foo() !dbg !22 {
ret void
}
More information about specific metadata nodes recognized by the optimizers and code generator is found below.
Specialized Metadata Nodes¶
Specialized metadata nodes are custom data structures in metadata (as opposed to generic tuples). Their fields are labelled, and can be specified in any order.
These aren’t inherently debug info centric, but currently all the specialized metadata nodes are related to debug info.
DICompileUnit¶
DICompileUnit
nodes represent a compile unit. The enums:
,
retainedTypes:
, subprograms:
, globals:
, imports:
and macros:
fields are tuples containing the debug info to be emitted along with the compile
unit, regardless of code optimizations (some nodes are only emitted if there are
references to them from instructions).
!0 = !DICompileUnit(language: DW_LANG_C99, file: !1, producer: "clang",
isOptimized: true, flags: "-O2", runtimeVersion: 2,
splitDebugFilename: "abc.debug", emissionKind: FullDebug,
enums: !2, retainedTypes: !3, subprograms: !4,
globals: !5, imports: !6, macros: !7, dwoId: 0x0abcd)
Compile unit descriptors provide the root scope for objects declared in a
specific compilation unit. File descriptors are defined using this scope.
These descriptors are collected by a named metadata !llvm.dbg.cu
. They
keep track of subprograms, global variables, type information, and imported
entities (declarations and namespaces).
DIFile¶
DIFile
nodes represent files. The filename:
can include slashes.
!0 = !DIFile(filename: "path/to/file", directory: "/path/to/dir")
Files are sometimes used in scope:
fields, and are the only valid target
for file:
fields.
DIBasicType¶
DIBasicType
nodes represent primitive types, such as int
, bool
and
float
. tag:
defaults to DW_TAG_base_type
.
!0 = !DIBasicType(name: "unsigned char", size: 8, align: 8,
encoding: DW_ATE_unsigned_char)
!1 = !DIBasicType(tag: DW_TAG_unspecified_type, name: "decltype(nullptr)")
The encoding:
describes the details of the type. Usually it’s one of the
following:
DW_ATE_address = 1
DW_ATE_boolean = 2
DW_ATE_float = 4
DW_ATE_signed = 5
DW_ATE_signed_char = 6
DW_ATE_unsigned = 7
DW_ATE_unsigned_char = 8
DISubroutineType¶
DISubroutineType
nodes represent subroutine types. Their types:
field
refers to a tuple; the first operand is the return type, while the rest are the
types of the formal arguments in order. If the first operand is null
, that
represents a function with no return value (such as void foo() {}
in C++).
!0 = !BasicType(name: "int", size: 32, align: 32, DW_ATE_signed)
!1 = !BasicType(name: "char", size: 8, align: 8, DW_ATE_signed_char)
!2 = !DISubroutineType(types: !{null, !0, !1}) ; void (int, char)
DIDerivedType¶
DIDerivedType
nodes represent types derived from other types, such as
qualified types.
!0 = !DIBasicType(name: "unsigned char", size: 8, align: 8,
encoding: DW_ATE_unsigned_char)
!1 = !DIDerivedType(tag: DW_TAG_pointer_type, baseType: !0, size: 32,
align: 32)
The following tag:
values are valid:
DW_TAG_formal_parameter = 5
DW_TAG_member = 13
DW_TAG_pointer_type = 15
DW_TAG_reference_type = 16
DW_TAG_typedef = 22
DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type = 31
DW_TAG_const_type = 38
DW_TAG_volatile_type = 53
DW_TAG_restrict_type = 55
DW_TAG_member
is used to define a member of a composite type or subprogram. The type of the member
is the baseType:
. The offset:
is the member’s bit offset.
DW_TAG_formal_parameter
is used to define a member which is a formal
argument of a subprogram.
DW_TAG_typedef
is used to provide a name for the baseType:
.
DW_TAG_pointer_type
, DW_TAG_reference_type
, DW_TAG_const_type
,
DW_TAG_volatile_type
and DW_TAG_restrict_type
are used to qualify the
baseType:
.
Note that the void *
type is expressed as a type derived from NULL.
DICompositeType¶
DICompositeType
nodes represent types composed of other types, like
structures and unions. elements:
points to a tuple of the composed types.
If the source language supports ODR, the identifier:
field gives the unique
identifier used for type merging between modules. When specified, other types
can refer to composite types indirectly via a metadata string that matches their identifier.
!0 = !DIEnumerator(name: "SixKind", value: 7)
!1 = !DIEnumerator(name: "SevenKind", value: 7)
!2 = !DIEnumerator(name: "NegEightKind", value: -8)
!3 = !DICompositeType(tag: DW_TAG_enumeration_type, name: "Enum", file: !12,
line: 2, size: 32, align: 32, identifier: "_M4Enum",
elements: !{!0, !1, !2})
The following tag:
values are valid:
DW_TAG_array_type = 1
DW_TAG_class_type = 2
DW_TAG_enumeration_type = 4
DW_TAG_structure_type = 19
DW_TAG_union_type = 23
DW_TAG_subroutine_type = 21
DW_TAG_inheritance = 28
For DW_TAG_array_type
, the elements:
should be subrange
descriptors, each representing the range of subscripts at that
level of indexing. The DIFlagVector
flag to flags:
indicates that an
array type is a native packed vector.
For DW_TAG_enumeration_type
, the elements:
should be enumerator
descriptors, each representing the definition of an enumeration
value for the set. All enumeration type descriptors are collected in the
enums:
field of the compile unit.
For DW_TAG_structure_type
, DW_TAG_class_type
, and
DW_TAG_union_type
, the elements:
should be derived types with tag: DW_TAG_member
or tag: DW_TAG_inheritance
.
DISubrange¶
DISubrange
nodes are the elements for DW_TAG_array_type
variants of
DICompositeType. count: -1
indicates an empty array.
!0 = !DISubrange(count: 5, lowerBound: 0) ; array counting from 0
!1 = !DISubrange(count: 5, lowerBound: 1) ; array counting from 1
!2 = !DISubrange(count: -1) ; empty array.
DIEnumerator¶
DIEnumerator
nodes are the elements for DW_TAG_enumeration_type
variants of DICompositeType.
!0 = !DIEnumerator(name: "SixKind", value: 7)
!1 = !DIEnumerator(name: "SevenKind", value: 7)
!2 = !DIEnumerator(name: "NegEightKind", value: -8)
DITemplateTypeParameter¶
DITemplateTypeParameter
nodes represent type parameters to generic source
language constructs. They are used (optionally) in DICompositeType and
DISubprogram templateParams:
fields.
!0 = !DITemplateTypeParameter(name: "Ty", type: !1)
DITemplateValueParameter¶
DITemplateValueParameter
nodes represent value parameters to generic source
language constructs. tag:
defaults to DW_TAG_template_value_parameter
,
but if specified can also be set to DW_TAG_GNU_template_template_param
or
DW_TAG_GNU_template_param_pack
. They are used (optionally) in
DICompositeType and DISubprogram templateParams:
fields.
!0 = !DITemplateValueParameter(name: "Ty", type: !1, value: i32 7)
DINamespace¶
DINamespace
nodes represent namespaces in the source language.
!0 = !DINamespace(name: "myawesomeproject", scope: !1, file: !2, line: 7)
DIGlobalVariable¶
DIGlobalVariable
nodes represent global variables in the source language.
!0 = !DIGlobalVariable(name: "foo", linkageName: "foo", scope: !1,
file: !2, line: 7, type: !3, isLocal: true,
isDefinition: false, variable: i32* @foo,
declaration: !4)
All global variables should be referenced by the globals: field of a compile unit.
DISubprogram¶
DISubprogram
nodes represent functions from the source language. A
DISubprogram
may be attached to a function definition using !dbg
metadata. The variables:
field points at variables
that must be retained, even if their IR counterparts are optimized out of
the IR. The type:
field must point at an DISubroutineType.
define void @_Z3foov() !dbg !0 {
...
}
!0 = distinct !DISubprogram(name: "foo", linkageName: "_Zfoov", scope: !1,
file: !2, line: 7, type: !3, isLocal: true,
isDefinition: false, scopeLine: 8,
containingType: !4,
virtuality: DW_VIRTUALITY_pure_virtual,
virtualIndex: 10, flags: DIFlagPrototyped,
isOptimized: true, templateParams: !5,
declaration: !6, variables: !7)
DILexicalBlock¶
DILexicalBlock
nodes describe nested blocks within a subprogram. The line number and column numbers are used to distinguish
two lexical blocks at same depth. They are valid targets for scope:
fields.
!0 = distinct !DILexicalBlock(scope: !1, file: !2, line: 7, column: 35)
Usually lexical blocks are distinct
to prevent node merging based on
operands.
DILexicalBlockFile¶
DILexicalBlockFile
nodes are used to discriminate between sections of a
lexical block. The file:
field can be changed to
indicate textual inclusion, or the discriminator:
field can be used to
discriminate between control flow within a single block in the source language.
!0 = !DILexicalBlock(scope: !3, file: !4, line: 7, column: 35)
!1 = !DILexicalBlockFile(scope: !0, file: !4, discriminator: 0)
!2 = !DILexicalBlockFile(scope: !0, file: !4, discriminator: 1)
DILocation¶
DILocation
nodes represent source debug locations. The scope:
field is
mandatory, and points at an DILexicalBlockFile, an
DILexicalBlock, or an DISubprogram.
!0 = !DILocation(line: 2900, column: 42, scope: !1, inlinedAt: !2)
DILocalVariable¶
DILocalVariable
nodes represent local variables in the source language. If
the arg:
field is set to non-zero, then this variable is a subprogram
parameter, and it will be included in the variables:
field of its
DISubprogram.
!0 = !DILocalVariable(name: "this", arg: 1, scope: !3, file: !2, line: 7,
type: !3, flags: DIFlagArtificial)
!1 = !DILocalVariable(name: "x", arg: 2, scope: !4, file: !2, line: 7,
type: !3)
!2 = !DILocalVariable(name: "y", scope: !5, file: !2, line: 7, type: !3)
DIExpression¶
DIExpression
nodes represent DWARF expression sequences. They are used in
debug intrinsics (such as llvm.dbg.declare
) to
describe how the referenced LLVM variable relates to the source language
variable.
The current supported vocabulary is limited:
DW_OP_deref
dereferences the working expression.DW_OP_plus, 93
adds93
to the working expression.DW_OP_bit_piece, 16, 8
specifies the offset and size (16
and8
here, respectively) of the variable piece from the working expression.
!0 = !DIExpression(DW_OP_deref)
!1 = !DIExpression(DW_OP_plus, 3)
!2 = !DIExpression(DW_OP_bit_piece, 3, 7)
!3 = !DIExpression(DW_OP_deref, DW_OP_plus, 3, DW_OP_bit_piece, 3, 7)
DIObjCProperty¶
DIObjCProperty
nodes represent Objective-C property nodes.
!3 = !DIObjCProperty(name: "foo", file: !1, line: 7, setter: "setFoo",
getter: "getFoo", attributes: 7, type: !2)
DIImportedEntity¶
DIImportedEntity
nodes represent entities (such as modules) imported into a
compile unit.
!2 = !DIImportedEntity(tag: DW_TAG_imported_module, name: "foo", scope: !0,
entity: !1, line: 7)
DIMacro¶
DIMacro
nodes represent definition or undefinition of a macro identifiers.
The name:
field is the macro identifier, followed by macro parameters when
definining a function-like macro, and the value
field is the token-string
used to expand the macro identifier.
!2 = !DIMacro(macinfo: DW_MACINFO_define, line: 7, name: "foo(x)",
value: "((x) + 1)")
!3 = !DIMacro(macinfo: DW_MACINFO_undef, line: 30, name: "foo")
DIMacroFile¶
DIMacroFile
nodes represent inclusion of source files.
The nodes:
field is a list of DIMacro
and DIMacroFile
nodes that
appear in the included source file.
!2 = !DIMacroFile(macinfo: DW_MACINFO_start_file, line: 7, file: !2,
nodes: !3)
‘tbaa
‘ Metadata¶
In LLVM IR, memory does not have types, so LLVM’s own type system is not suitable for doing TBAA. Instead, metadata is added to the IR to describe a type system of a higher level language. This can be used to implement typical C/C++ TBAA, but it can also be used to implement custom alias analysis behavior for other languages.
The current metadata format is very simple. TBAA metadata nodes have up to three fields, e.g.:
!0 = !{ !"an example type tree" }
!1 = !{ !"int", !0 }
!2 = !{ !"float", !0 }
!3 = !{ !"const float", !2, i64 1 }
The first field is an identity field. It can be any value, usually a metadata string, which uniquely identifies the type. The most important name in the tree is the name of the root node. Two trees with different root node names are entirely disjoint, even if they have leaves with common names.
The second field identifies the type’s parent node in the tree, or is null or omitted for a root node. A type is considered to alias all of its descendants and all of its ancestors in the tree. Also, a type is considered to alias all types in other trees, so that bitcode produced from multiple front-ends is handled conservatively.
If the third field is present, it’s an integer which if equal to 1
indicates that the type is “constant” (meaning
pointsToConstantMemory
should return true; see other useful
AliasAnalysis methods).
‘tbaa.struct
‘ Metadata¶
The llvm.memcpy is often used to implement aggregate assignment operations in C and similar languages, however it is defined to copy a contiguous region of memory, which is more than strictly necessary for aggregate types which contain holes due to padding. Also, it doesn’t contain any TBAA information about the fields of the aggregate.
!tbaa.struct
metadata can describe which memory subregions in a
memcpy are padding and what the TBAA tags of the struct are.
The current metadata format is very simple. !tbaa.struct
metadata
nodes are a list of operands which are in conceptual groups of three.
For each group of three, the first operand gives the byte offset of a
field in bytes, the second gives its size in bytes, and the third gives
its tbaa tag. e.g.:
!4 = !{ i64 0, i64 4, !1, i64 8, i64 4, !2 }
This describes a struct with two fields. The first is at offset 0 bytes with size 4 bytes, and has tbaa tag !1. The second is at offset 8 bytes and has size 4 bytes and has tbaa tag !2.
Note that the fields need not be contiguous. In this example, there is a 4 byte gap between the two fields. This gap represents padding which does not carry useful data and need not be preserved.
‘noalias
‘ and ‘alias.scope
‘ Metadata¶
noalias
and alias.scope
metadata provide the ability to specify generic
noalias memory-access sets. This means that some collection of memory access
instructions (loads, stores, memory-accessing calls, etc.) that carry
noalias
metadata can specifically be specified not to alias with some other
collection of memory access instructions that carry alias.scope
metadata.
Each type of metadata specifies a list of scopes where each scope has an id and
a domain. When evaluating an aliasing query, if for some domain, the set
of scopes with that domain in one instruction’s alias.scope
list is a
subset of (or equal to) the set of scopes for that domain in another
instruction’s noalias
list, then the two memory accesses are assumed not to
alias.
The metadata identifying each domain is itself a list containing one or two entries. The first entry is the name of the domain. Note that if the name is a string then it can be combined across functions and translation units. A self-reference can be used to create globally unique domain names. A descriptive string may optionally be provided as a second list entry.
The metadata identifying each scope is also itself a list containing two or three entries. The first entry is the name of the scope. Note that if the name is a string then it can be combined across functions and translation units. A self-reference can be used to create globally unique scope names. A metadata reference to the scope’s domain is the second entry. A descriptive string may optionally be provided as a third list entry.
For example,
; Two scope domains:
!0 = !{!0}
!1 = !{!1}
; Some scopes in these domains:
!2 = !{!2, !0}
!3 = !{!3, !0}
!4 = !{!4, !1}
; Some scope lists:
!5 = !{!4} ; A list containing only scope !4
!6 = !{!4, !3, !2}
!7 = !{!3}
; These two instructions don't alias:
%0 = load float, float* %c, align 4, !alias.scope !5
store float %0, float* %arrayidx.i, align 4, !noalias !5
; These two instructions also don't alias (for domain !1, the set of scopes
; in the !alias.scope equals that in the !noalias list):
%2 = load float, float* %c, align 4, !alias.scope !5
store float %2, float* %arrayidx.i2, align 4, !noalias !6
; These two instructions may alias (for domain !0, the set of scopes in
; the !noalias list is not a superset of, or equal to, the scopes in the
; !alias.scope list):
%2 = load float, float* %c, align 4, !alias.scope !6
store float %0, float* %arrayidx.i, align 4, !noalias !7
‘fpmath
‘ Metadata¶
fpmath
metadata may be attached to any instruction of floating point
type. It can be used to express the maximum acceptable error in the
result of that instruction, in ULPs, thus potentially allowing the
compiler to use a more efficient but less accurate method of computing
it. ULP is defined as follows:
Ifx
is a real number that lies between two finite consecutive floating-point numbersa
andb
, without being equal to one of them, thenulp(x) = |b - a|
, otherwiseulp(x)
is the distance between the two non-equal finite floating-point numbers nearestx
. Moreover,ulp(NaN)
isNaN
.
The metadata node shall consist of a single positive floating point number representing the maximum relative error, for example:
!0 = !{ float 2.5 } ; maximum acceptable inaccuracy is 2.5 ULPs
‘range
‘ Metadata¶
range
metadata may be attached only to load
, call
and invoke
of
integer types. It expresses the possible ranges the loaded value or the value
returned by the called function at this call site is in. The ranges are
represented with a flattened list of integers. The loaded value or the value
returned is known to be in the union of the ranges defined by each consecutive
pair. Each pair has the following properties:
- The type must match the type loaded by the instruction.
- The pair
a,b
represents the range[a,b)
. - Both
a
andb
are constants. - The range is allowed to wrap.
- The range should not represent the full or empty set. That is,
a!=b
.
In addition, the pairs must be in signed order of the lower bound and they must be non-contiguous.
Examples:
%a = load i8, i8* %x, align 1, !range !0 ; Can only be 0 or 1
%b = load i8, i8* %y, align 1, !range !1 ; Can only be 255 (-1), 0 or 1
%c = call i8 @foo(), !range !2 ; Can only be 0, 1, 3, 4 or 5
%d = invoke i8 @bar() to label %cont
unwind label %lpad, !range !3 ; Can only be -2, -1, 3, 4 or 5
...
!0 = !{ i8 0, i8 2 }
!1 = !{ i8 255, i8 2 }
!2 = !{ i8 0, i8 2, i8 3, i8 6 }
!3 = !{ i8 -2, i8 0, i8 3, i8 6 }
‘unpredictable
‘ Metadata¶
unpredictable
metadata may be attached to any branch or switch
instruction. It can be used to express the unpredictability of control
flow. Similar to the llvm.expect intrinsic, it may be used to alter
optimizations related to compare and branch instructions. The metadata
is treated as a boolean value; if it exists, it signals that the branch
or switch that it is attached to is completely unpredictable.
‘llvm.loop
Ԧ
It is sometimes useful to attach information to loop constructs. Currently,
loop metadata is implemented as metadata attached to the branch instruction
in the loop latch block. This type of metadata refer to a metadata node that is
guaranteed to be separate for each loop. The loop identifier metadata is
specified with the name llvm.loop
.
The loop identifier metadata is implemented using a metadata that refers to itself to avoid merging it with any other identifier metadata, e.g., during module linkage or function inlining. That is, each loop should refer to their own identification metadata even if they reside in separate functions. The following example contains loop identifier metadata for two separate loop constructs:
!0 = !{!0}
!1 = !{!1}
The loop identifier metadata can be used to specify additional
per-loop metadata. Any operands after the first operand can be treated
as user-defined metadata. For example the llvm.loop.unroll.count
suggests an unroll factor to the loop unroller:
br i1 %exitcond, label %._crit_edge, label %.lr.ph, !llvm.loop !0
...
!0 = !{!0, !1}
!1 = !{!"llvm.loop.unroll.count", i32 4}
‘llvm.loop.vectorize
‘ and ‘llvm.loop.interleave
Ԧ
Metadata prefixed with llvm.loop.vectorize
or llvm.loop.interleave
are
used to control per-loop vectorization and interleaving parameters such as
vectorization width and interleave count. These metadata should be used in
conjunction with llvm.loop
loop identification metadata. The
llvm.loop.vectorize
and llvm.loop.interleave
metadata are only
optimization hints and the optimizer will only interleave and vectorize loops if
it believes it is safe to do so. The llvm.mem.parallel_loop_access
metadata
which contains information about loop-carried memory dependencies can be helpful
in determining the safety of these transformations.
‘llvm.loop.interleave.count
‘ Metadata¶
This metadata suggests an interleave count to the loop interleaver.
The first operand is the string llvm.loop.interleave.count
and the
second operand is an integer specifying the interleave count. For
example:
!0 = !{!"llvm.loop.interleave.count", i32 4}
Note that setting llvm.loop.interleave.count
to 1 disables interleaving
multiple iterations of the loop. If llvm.loop.interleave.count
is set to 0
then the interleave count will be determined automatically.
‘llvm.loop.vectorize.enable
‘ Metadata¶
This metadata selectively enables or disables vectorization for the loop. The
first operand is the string llvm.loop.vectorize.enable
and the second operand
is a bit. If the bit operand value is 1 vectorization is enabled. A value of
0 disables vectorization:
!0 = !{!"llvm.loop.vectorize.enable", i1 0}
!1 = !{!"llvm.loop.vectorize.enable", i1 1}
‘llvm.loop.vectorize.width
‘ Metadata¶
This metadata sets the target width of the vectorizer. The first
operand is the string llvm.loop.vectorize.width
and the second
operand is an integer specifying the width. For example:
!0 = !{!"llvm.loop.vectorize.width", i32 4}
Note that setting llvm.loop.vectorize.width
to 1 disables
vectorization of the loop. If llvm.loop.vectorize.width
is set to
0 or if the loop does not have this metadata the width will be
determined automatically.
‘llvm.loop.unroll
Ԧ
Metadata prefixed with llvm.loop.unroll
are loop unrolling
optimization hints such as the unroll factor. llvm.loop.unroll
metadata should be used in conjunction with llvm.loop
loop
identification metadata. The llvm.loop.unroll
metadata are only
optimization hints and the unrolling will only be performed if the
optimizer believes it is safe to do so.
‘llvm.loop.unroll.count
‘ Metadata¶
This metadata suggests an unroll factor to the loop unroller. The
first operand is the string llvm.loop.unroll.count
and the second
operand is a positive integer specifying the unroll factor. For
example:
!0 = !{!"llvm.loop.unroll.count", i32 4}
If the trip count of the loop is less than the unroll count the loop will be partially unrolled.
‘llvm.loop.unroll.disable
‘ Metadata¶
This metadata disables loop unrolling. The metadata has a single operand
which is the string llvm.loop.unroll.disable
. For example:
!0 = !{!"llvm.loop.unroll.disable"}
‘llvm.loop.unroll.runtime.disable
‘ Metadata¶
This metadata disables runtime loop unrolling. The metadata has a single
operand which is the string llvm.loop.unroll.runtime.disable
. For example:
!0 = !{!"llvm.loop.unroll.runtime.disable"}
‘llvm.loop.unroll.enable
‘ Metadata¶
This metadata suggests that the loop should be fully unrolled if the trip count
is known at compile time and partially unrolled if the trip count is not known
at compile time. The metadata has a single operand which is the string
llvm.loop.unroll.enable
. For example:
!0 = !{!"llvm.loop.unroll.enable"}
‘llvm.loop.unroll.full
‘ Metadata¶
This metadata suggests that the loop should be unrolled fully. The
metadata has a single operand which is the string llvm.loop.unroll.full
.
For example:
!0 = !{!"llvm.loop.unroll.full"}
‘llvm.loop.licm_versioning.disable
‘ Metadata¶
This metadata indicates that the loop should not be versioned for the purpose
of enabling loop-invariant code motion (LICM). The metadata has a single operand
which is the string llvm.loop.licm_versioning.disable
. For example:
!0 = !{!"llvm.loop.licm_versioning.disable"}
‘llvm.mem
Ԧ
Metadata types used to annotate memory accesses with information helpful
for optimizations are prefixed with llvm.mem
.
‘llvm.mem.parallel_loop_access
‘ Metadata¶
The llvm.mem.parallel_loop_access
metadata refers to a loop identifier,
or metadata containing a list of loop identifiers for nested loops.
The metadata is attached to memory accessing instructions and denotes that
no loop carried memory dependence exist between it and other instructions denoted
with the same loop identifier.
Precisely, given two instructions m1
and m2
that both have the
llvm.mem.parallel_loop_access
metadata, with L1
and L2
being the
set of loops associated with that metadata, respectively, then there is no loop
carried dependence between m1
and m2
for loops in both L1
and
L2
.
As a special case, if all memory accessing instructions in a loop have
llvm.mem.parallel_loop_access
metadata that refers to that loop, then the
loop has no loop carried memory dependences and is considered to be a parallel
loop.
Note that if not all memory access instructions have such metadata referring to the loop, then the loop is considered not being trivially parallel. Additional memory dependence analysis is required to make that determination. As a fail safe mechanism, this causes loops that were originally parallel to be considered sequential (if optimization passes that are unaware of the parallel semantics insert new memory instructions into the loop body).
Example of a loop that is considered parallel due to its correct use of
both llvm.loop
and llvm.mem.parallel_loop_access
metadata types that refer to the same loop identifier metadata.
for.body:
...
%val0 = load i32, i32* %arrayidx, !llvm.mem.parallel_loop_access !0
...
store i32 %val0, i32* %arrayidx1, !llvm.mem.parallel_loop_access !0
...
br i1 %exitcond, label %for.end, label %for.body, !llvm.loop !0
for.end:
...
!0 = !{!0}
It is also possible to have nested parallel loops. In that case the memory accesses refer to a list of loop identifier metadata nodes instead of the loop identifier metadata node directly:
outer.for.body:
...
%val1 = load i32, i32* %arrayidx3, !llvm.mem.parallel_loop_access !2
...
br label %inner.for.body
inner.for.body:
...
%val0 = load i32, i32* %arrayidx1, !llvm.mem.parallel_loop_access !0
...
store i32 %val0, i32* %arrayidx2, !llvm.mem.parallel_loop_access !0
...
br i1 %exitcond, label %inner.for.end, label %inner.for.body, !llvm.loop !1
inner.for.end:
...
store i32 %val1, i32* %arrayidx4, !llvm.mem.parallel_loop_access !2
...
br i1 %exitcond, label %outer.for.end, label %outer.for.body, !llvm.loop !2
outer.for.end: ; preds = %for.body
...
!0 = !{!1, !2} ; a list of loop identifiers
!1 = !{!1} ; an identifier for the inner loop
!2 = !{!2} ; an identifier for the outer loop
‘llvm.bitsets
Ԧ
The llvm.bitsets
global metadata is used to implement
bitsets.
‘invariant.group
‘ Metadata¶
The invariant.group
metadata may be attached to load
/store
instructions.
The existence of the invariant.group
metadata on the instruction tells
the optimizer that every load
and store
to the same pointer operand
within the same invariant group can be assumed to load or store the same
value (but see the llvm.invariant.group.barrier
intrinsic which affects
when two pointers are considered the same).
Examples:
@unknownPtr = external global i8
...
%ptr = alloca i8
store i8 42, i8* %ptr, !invariant.group !0
call void @foo(i8* %ptr)
%a = load i8, i8* %ptr, !invariant.group !0 ; Can assume that value under %ptr didn't change
call void @foo(i8* %ptr)
%b = load i8, i8* %ptr, !invariant.group !1 ; Can't assume anything, because group changed
%newPtr = call i8* @getPointer(i8* %ptr)
%c = load i8, i8* %newPtr, !invariant.group !0 ; Can't assume anything, because we only have information about %ptr
%unknownValue = load i8, i8* @unknownPtr
store i8 %unknownValue, i8* %ptr, !invariant.group !0 ; Can assume that %unknownValue == 42
call void @foo(i8* %ptr)
%newPtr2 = call i8* @llvm.invariant.group.barrier(i8* %ptr)
%d = load i8, i8* %newPtr2, !invariant.group !0 ; Can't step through invariant.group.barrier to get value of %ptr
...
declare void @foo(i8*)
declare i8* @getPointer(i8*)
declare i8* @llvm.invariant.group.barrier(i8*)
!0 = !{!"magic ptr"}
!1 = !{!"other ptr"}
Module Flags Metadata¶
Information about the module as a whole is difficult to convey to LLVM’s
subsystems. The LLVM IR isn’t sufficient to transmit this information.
The llvm.module.flags
named metadata exists in order to facilitate
this. These flags are in the form of key / value pairs — much like a
dictionary — making it easy for any subsystem who cares about a flag to
look it up.
The llvm.module.flags
metadata contains a list of metadata triplets.
Each triplet has the following form:
- The first element is a behavior flag, which specifies the behavior when two (or more) modules are merged together, and it encounters two (or more) metadata with the same ID. The supported behaviors are described below.
- The second element is a metadata string that is a unique ID for the metadata. Each module may only have one flag entry for each unique ID (not including entries with the Require behavior).
- The third element is the value of the flag.
When two (or more) modules are merged together, the resulting
llvm.module.flags
metadata is the union of the modules’ flags. That is, for
each unique metadata ID string, there will be exactly one entry in the merged
modules llvm.module.flags
metadata table, and the value for that entry will
be determined by the merge behavior flag, as described below. The only exception
is that entries with the Require behavior are always preserved.
The following behaviors are supported:
Value | Behavior |
---|---|
1 |
|
2 |
|
3 |
|
4 |
|
5 |
|
6 |
|
It is an error for a particular unique flag ID to have multiple behaviors, except in the case of Require (which adds restrictions on another metadata value) or Override.
An example of module flags:
!0 = !{ i32 1, !"foo", i32 1 }
!1 = !{ i32 4, !"bar", i32 37 }
!2 = !{ i32 2, !"qux", i32 42 }
!3 = !{ i32 3, !"qux",
!{
!"foo", i32 1
}
}
!llvm.module.flags = !{ !0, !1, !2, !3 }
Metadata
!0
has the ID!"foo"
and the value ‘1’. The behavior if two or more!"foo"
flags are seen is to emit an error if their values are not equal.Metadata
!1
has the ID!"bar"
and the value ‘37’. The behavior if two or more!"bar"
flags are seen is to use the value ‘37’.Metadata
!2
has the ID!"qux"
and the value ‘42’. The behavior if two or more!"qux"
flags are seen is to emit a warning if their values are not equal.Metadata
!3
has the ID!"qux"
and the value:!{ !"foo", i32 1 }
The behavior is to emit an error if the
llvm.module.flags
does not contain a flag with the ID!"foo"
that has the value ‘1’ after linking is performed.
Objective-C Garbage Collection Module Flags Metadata¶
On the Mach-O platform, Objective-C stores metadata about garbage collection in a special section called “image info”. The metadata consists of a version number and a bitmask specifying what types of garbage collection are supported (if any) by the file. If two or more modules are linked together their garbage collection metadata needs to be merged rather than appended together.
The Objective-C garbage collection module flags metadata consists of the following key-value pairs:
Key | Value |
---|---|
Objective-C Version |
[Required] — The Objective-C ABI version. Valid values are 1 and 2. |
Objective-C Image Info Version |
[Required] — The version of the image info section. Currently always 0. |
Objective-C Image Info Section |
[Required] — The section to place the metadata. Valid values are
"__OBJC, __image_info, regular" for Objective-C ABI version 1, and
"__DATA,__objc_imageinfo, regular, no_dead_strip" for
Objective-C ABI version 2. |
Objective-C Garbage Collection |
[Required] — Specifies whether garbage collection is supported or not. Valid values are 0, for no garbage collection, and 2, for garbage collection supported. |
Objective-C GC Only |
[Optional] — Specifies that only garbage collection is supported.
If present, its value must be 6. This flag requires that the
Objective-C Garbage Collection flag have the value 2. |
Some important flag interactions:
- If a module with
Objective-C Garbage Collection
set to 0 is merged with a module withObjective-C Garbage Collection
set to 2, then the resulting module has theObjective-C Garbage Collection
flag set to 0. - A module with
Objective-C Garbage Collection
set to 0 cannot be merged with a module withObjective-C GC Only
set to 6.
Automatic Linker Flags Module Flags Metadata¶
Some targets support embedding flags to the linker inside individual object files. Typically this is used in conjunction with language extensions which allow source files to explicitly declare the libraries they depend on, and have these automatically be transmitted to the linker via object files.
These flags are encoded in the IR using metadata in the module flags section,
using the Linker Options
key. The merge behavior for this flag is required
to be AppendUnique
, and the value for the key is expected to be a metadata
node which should be a list of other metadata nodes, each of which should be a
list of metadata strings defining linker options.
For example, the following metadata section specifies two separate sets of
linker options, presumably to link against libz
and the Cocoa
framework:
!0 = !{ i32 6, !"Linker Options",
!{
!{ !"-lz" },
!{ !"-framework", !"Cocoa" } } }
!llvm.module.flags = !{ !0 }
The metadata encoding as lists of lists of options, as opposed to a collapsed list of options, is chosen so that the IR encoding can use multiple option strings to specify e.g., a single library, while still having that specifier be preserved as an atomic element that can be recognized by a target specific assembly writer or object file emitter.
Each individual option is required to be either a valid option for the target’s linker, or an option that is reserved by the target specific assembly writer or object file emitter. No other aspect of these options is defined by the IR.
C type width Module Flags Metadata¶
The ARM backend emits a section into each generated object file describing the options that it was compiled with (in a compiler-independent way) to prevent linking incompatible objects, and to allow automatic library selection. Some of these options are not visible at the IR level, namely wchar_t width and enum width.
To pass this information to the backend, these options are encoded in module flags metadata, using the following key-value pairs:
Key | Value |
---|---|
short_wchar |
|
short_enum |
|
For example, the following metadata section specifies that the module was
compiled with a wchar_t
width of 4 bytes, and the underlying type of an
enum is the smallest type which can represent all of its values:
!llvm.module.flags = !{!0, !1}
!0 = !{i32 1, !"short_wchar", i32 1}
!1 = !{i32 1, !"short_enum", i32 0}
Intrinsic Global Variables¶
LLVM has a number of “magic” global variables that contain data that
affect code generation or other IR semantics. These are documented here.
All globals of this sort should have a section specified as
“llvm.metadata
”. This section and all globals that start with
“llvm.
” are reserved for use by LLVM.
The ‘llvm.used
‘ Global Variable¶
The @llvm.used
global is an array which has
appending linkage. This array contains a list of
pointers to named global variables, functions and aliases which may optionally
have a pointer cast formed of bitcast or getelementptr. For example, a legal
use of it is:
@X = global i8 4
@Y = global i32 123
@llvm.used = appending global [2 x i8*] [
i8* @X,
i8* bitcast (i32* @Y to i8*)
], section "llvm.metadata"
If a symbol appears in the @llvm.used
list, then the compiler, assembler,
and linker are required to treat the symbol as if there is a reference to the
symbol that it cannot see (which is why they have to be named). For example, if
a variable has internal linkage and no references other than that from the
@llvm.used
list, it cannot be deleted. This is commonly used to represent
references from inline asms and other things the compiler cannot “see”, and
corresponds to “attribute((used))
” in GNU C.
On some targets, the code generator must emit a directive to the assembler or object file to prevent the assembler and linker from molesting the symbol.
The ‘llvm.compiler.used
‘ Global Variable¶
The @llvm.compiler.used
directive is the same as the @llvm.used
directive, except that it only prevents the compiler from touching the
symbol. On targets that support it, this allows an intelligent linker to
optimize references to the symbol without being impeded as it would be
by @llvm.used
.
This is a rare construct that should only be used in rare circumstances, and should not be exposed to source languages.
The ‘llvm.global_ctors
‘ Global Variable¶
%0 = type { i32, void ()*, i8* }
@llvm.global_ctors = appending global [1 x %0] [%0 { i32 65535, void ()* @ctor, i8* @data }]
The @llvm.global_ctors
array contains a list of constructor
functions, priorities, and an optional associated global or function.
The functions referenced by this array will be called in ascending order
of priority (i.e. lowest first) when the module is loaded. The order of
functions with the same priority is not defined.
If the third field is present, non-null, and points to a global variable or function, the initializer function will only run if the associated data from the current module is not discarded.
The ‘llvm.global_dtors
‘ Global Variable¶
%0 = type { i32, void ()*, i8* }
@llvm.global_dtors = appending global [1 x %0] [%0 { i32 65535, void ()* @dtor, i8* @data }]
The @llvm.global_dtors
array contains a list of destructor
functions, priorities, and an optional associated global or function.
The functions referenced by this array will be called in descending
order of priority (i.e. highest first) when the module is unloaded. The
order of functions with the same priority is not defined.
If the third field is present, non-null, and points to a global variable or function, the destructor function will only run if the associated data from the current module is not discarded.
Instruction Reference¶
The LLVM instruction set consists of several different classifications of instructions: terminator instructions, binary instructions, bitwise binary instructions, memory instructions, and other instructions.
Terminator Instructions¶
As mentioned previously, every basic block in a
program ends with a “Terminator” instruction, which indicates which
block should be executed after the current block is finished. These
terminator instructions typically yield a ‘void
‘ value: they produce
control flow, not values (the one exception being the
‘invoke‘ instruction).
The terminator instructions are: ‘ret‘, ‘br‘, ‘switch‘, ‘indirectbr‘, ‘invoke‘, ‘resume‘, ‘catchswitch‘, ‘catchret‘, ‘cleanupret‘, and ‘unreachable‘.
‘ret
‘ Instruction¶
Syntax:¶
ret <type> <value> ; Return a value from a non-void function
ret void ; Return from void function
Overview:¶
The ‘ret
‘ instruction is used to return control flow (and optionally
a value) from a function back to the caller.
There are two forms of the ‘ret
‘ instruction: one that returns a
value and then causes control flow, and one that just causes control
flow to occur.
Arguments:¶
The ‘ret
‘ instruction optionally accepts a single argument, the
return value. The type of the return value must be a ‘first
class‘ type.
A function is not well formed if it it has a non-void
return type and contains a ‘ret
‘ instruction with no return value or
a return value with a type that does not match its type, or if it has a
void return type and contains a ‘ret
‘ instruction with a return
value.
Semantics:¶
When the ‘ret
‘ instruction is executed, control flow returns back to
the calling function’s context. If the caller is a
“call” instruction, execution continues at the
instruction after the call. If the caller was an
“invoke” instruction, execution continues at the
beginning of the “normal” destination block. If the instruction returns
a value, that value shall set the call or invoke instruction’s return
value.
‘br
‘ Instruction¶
Overview:¶
The ‘br
‘ instruction is used to cause control flow to transfer to a
different basic block in the current function. There are two forms of
this instruction, corresponding to a conditional branch and an
unconditional branch.
Arguments:¶
The conditional branch form of the ‘br
‘ instruction takes a single
‘i1
‘ value and two ‘label
‘ values. The unconditional form of the
‘br
‘ instruction takes a single ‘label
‘ value as a target.
Semantics:¶
Upon execution of a conditional ‘br
‘ instruction, the ‘i1
‘
argument is evaluated. If the value is true
, control flows to the
‘iftrue
‘ label
argument. If “cond” is false
, control flows
to the ‘iffalse
‘ label
argument.
‘switch
‘ Instruction¶
Overview:¶
The ‘switch
‘ instruction is used to transfer control flow to one of
several different places. It is a generalization of the ‘br
‘
instruction, allowing a branch to occur to one of many possible
destinations.
Arguments:¶
The ‘switch
‘ instruction uses three parameters: an integer
comparison value ‘value
‘, a default ‘label
‘ destination, and an
array of pairs of comparison value constants and ‘label
‘s. The table
is not allowed to contain duplicate constant entries.
Semantics:¶
The switch
instruction specifies a table of values and destinations.
When the ‘switch
‘ instruction is executed, this table is searched
for the given value. If the value is found, control flow is transferred
to the corresponding destination; otherwise, control flow is transferred
to the default destination.
Implementation:¶
Depending on properties of the target machine and the particular
switch
instruction, this instruction may be code generated in
different ways. For example, it could be generated as a series of
chained conditional branches or with a lookup table.
Example:¶
; Emulate a conditional br instruction
%Val = zext i1 %value to i32
switch i32 %Val, label %truedest [ i32 0, label %falsedest ]
; Emulate an unconditional br instruction
switch i32 0, label %dest [ ]
; Implement a jump table:
switch i32 %val, label %otherwise [ i32 0, label %onzero
i32 1, label %onone
i32 2, label %ontwo ]
‘indirectbr
‘ Instruction¶
Overview:¶
The ‘indirectbr
‘ instruction implements an indirect branch to a
label within the current function, whose address is specified by
“address
”. Address must be derived from a
blockaddress constant.
Arguments:¶
The ‘address
‘ argument is the address of the label to jump to. The
rest of the arguments indicate the full set of possible destinations
that the address may point to. Blocks are allowed to occur multiple
times in the destination list, though this isn’t particularly useful.
This destination list is required so that dataflow analysis has an accurate understanding of the CFG.
Semantics:¶
Control transfers to the block specified in the address argument. All possible destination blocks must be listed in the label list, otherwise this instruction has undefined behavior. This implies that jumps to labels defined in other functions have undefined behavior as well.
Implementation:¶
This is typically implemented with a jump through a register.
‘invoke
‘ Instruction¶
Syntax:¶
<result> = invoke [cconv] [ret attrs] <ptr to function ty> <function ptr val>(<function args>) [fn attrs]
[operand bundles] to label <normal label> unwind label <exception label>
Overview:¶
The ‘invoke
‘ instruction causes control to transfer to a specified
function, with the possibility of control flow transfer to either the
‘normal
‘ label or the ‘exception
‘ label. If the callee function
returns with the “ret
” instruction, control flow will return to the
“normal” label. If the callee (or any indirect callees) returns via the
“resume” instruction or other exception handling
mechanism, control is interrupted and continued at the dynamically
nearest “exception” label.
The ‘exception
‘ label is a landing
pad for the exception. As such,
‘exception
‘ label is required to have the
“landingpad” instruction, which contains the
information about the behavior of the program after unwinding happens,
as its first non-PHI instruction. The restrictions on the
“landingpad
” instruction’s tightly couples it to the “invoke
”
instruction, so that the important information contained within the
“landingpad
” instruction can’t be lost through normal code motion.
Arguments:¶
This instruction requires several arguments:
- The optional “cconv” marker indicates which calling convention the call should use. If none is specified, the call defaults to using C calling conventions.
- The optional Parameter Attributes list for return
values. Only ‘
zeroext
‘, ‘signext
‘, and ‘inreg
‘ attributes are valid here. - ‘
ptr to function ty
‘: shall be the signature of the pointer to function value being invoked. In most cases, this is a direct function invocation, but indirectinvoke
‘s are just as possible, branching off an arbitrary pointer to function value. - ‘
function ptr val
‘: An LLVM value containing a pointer to a function to be invoked. - ‘
function args
‘: argument list whose types match the function signature argument types and parameter attributes. All arguments must be of first class type. If the function signature indicates the function accepts a variable number of arguments, the extra arguments can be specified. - ‘
normal label
‘: the label reached when the called function executes a ‘ret
‘ instruction. - ‘
exception label
‘: the label reached when a callee returns via the resume instruction or other exception handling mechanism. - The optional function attributes list. Only
‘
noreturn
‘, ‘nounwind
‘, ‘readonly
‘ and ‘readnone
‘ attributes are valid here. - The optional operand bundles list.
Semantics:¶
This instruction is designed to operate as a standard ‘call
‘
instruction in most regards. The primary difference is that it
establishes an association with a label, which is used by the runtime
library to unwind the stack.
This instruction is used in languages with destructors to ensure that
proper cleanup is performed in the case of either a longjmp
or a
thrown exception. Additionally, this is important for implementation of
‘catch
‘ clauses in high-level languages that support them.
For the purposes of the SSA form, the definition of the value returned
by the ‘invoke
‘ instruction is deemed to occur on the edge from the
current block to the “normal” label. If the callee unwinds then no
return value is available.
‘resume
‘ Instruction¶
Arguments:¶
The ‘resume
‘ instruction requires one argument, which must have the
same type as the result of any ‘landingpad
‘ instruction in the same
function.
Semantics:¶
The ‘resume
‘ instruction resumes propagation of an existing
(in-flight) exception whose unwinding was interrupted with a
landingpad instruction.
‘catchswitch
‘ Instruction¶
Syntax:¶
<resultval> = catchswitch within <parent> [ label <handler1>, label <handler2>, ... ] unwind to caller
<resultval> = catchswitch within <parent> [ label <handler1>, label <handler2>, ... ] unwind label <default>
Overview:¶
The ‘catchswitch
‘ instruction is used by LLVM’s exception handling system to describe the set of possible catch handlers
that may be executed by the EH personality routine.
Arguments:¶
The parent
argument is the token of the funclet that contains the
catchswitch
instruction. If the catchswitch
is not inside a funclet,
this operand may be the token none
.
The default
argument is the label of another basic block beginning with
either a cleanuppad
or catchswitch
instruction. This unwind destination
must be a legal target with respect to the parent
links, as described in
the exception handling documentation.
The handlers
are a nonempty list of successor blocks that each begin with a
catchpad instruction.
Semantics:¶
Executing this instruction transfers control to one of the successors in
handlers
, if appropriate, or continues to unwind via the unwind label if
present.
The catchswitch
is both a terminator and a “pad” instruction, meaning that
it must be both the first non-phi instruction and last instruction in the basic
block. Therefore, it must be the only non-phi instruction in the block.
‘catchret
‘ Instruction¶
Arguments:¶
The first argument to a ‘catchret
‘ indicates which catchpad
it
exits. It must be a catchpad.
The second argument to a ‘catchret
‘ specifies where control will
transfer to next.
Semantics:¶
The ‘catchret
‘ instruction ends an existing (in-flight) exception whose
unwinding was interrupted with a catchpad instruction. The
personality function gets a chance to execute arbitrary
code to, for example, destroy the active exception. Control then transfers to
normal
.
The token
argument must be a token produced by a catchpad
instruction.
If the specified catchpad
is not the most-recently-entered not-yet-exited
funclet pad (as described in the EH documentation),
the catchret
‘s behavior is undefined.
‘cleanupret
‘ Instruction¶
Arguments:¶
The ‘cleanupret
‘ instruction requires one argument, which indicates
which cleanuppad
it exits, and must be a cleanuppad.
If the specified cleanuppad
is not the most-recently-entered not-yet-exited
funclet pad (as described in the EH documentation),
the cleanupret
‘s behavior is undefined.
The ‘cleanupret
‘ instruction also has an optional successor, continue
,
which must be the label of another basic block beginning with either a
cleanuppad
or catchswitch
instruction. This unwind destination must
be a legal target with respect to the parent
links, as described in the
exception handling documentation.
Semantics:¶
The ‘cleanupret
‘ instruction indicates to the
personality function that one
cleanuppad it transferred control to has ended.
It transfers control to continue
or unwinds out of the function.
‘unreachable
‘ Instruction¶
Overview:¶
The ‘unreachable
‘ instruction has no defined semantics. This
instruction is used to inform the optimizer that a particular portion of
the code is not reachable. This can be used to indicate that the code
after a no-return function cannot be reached, and other facts.
Semantics:¶
The ‘unreachable
‘ instruction has no defined semantics.
Binary Operations¶
Binary operators are used to do most of the computation in a program. They require two operands of the same type, execute an operation on them, and produce a single value. The operands might represent multiple data, as is the case with the vector data type. The result value has the same type as its operands.
There are several different binary operators:
‘add
‘ Instruction¶
Syntax:¶
<result> = add <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
<result> = add nuw <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
<result> = add nsw <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
<result> = add nuw nsw <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
Arguments:¶
The two arguments to the ‘add
‘ instruction must be
integer or vector of integer values. Both
arguments must have identical types.
Semantics:¶
The value produced is the integer sum of the two operands.
If the sum has unsigned overflow, the result returned is the mathematical result modulo 2n, where n is the bit width of the result.
Because LLVM integers use a two’s complement representation, this instruction is appropriate for both signed and unsigned integers.
nuw
and nsw
stand for “No Unsigned Wrap” and “No Signed Wrap”,
respectively. If the nuw
and/or nsw
keywords are present, the
result value of the add
is a poison value if
unsigned and/or signed overflow, respectively, occurs.
‘fadd
‘ Instruction¶
Arguments:¶
The two arguments to the ‘fadd
‘ instruction must be floating
point or vector of floating point values.
Both arguments must have identical types.
Semantics:¶
The value produced is the floating point sum of the two operands. This instruction can also take any number of fast-math flags, which are optimization hints to enable otherwise unsafe floating point optimizations:
‘sub
‘ Instruction¶
Syntax:¶
<result> = sub <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
<result> = sub nuw <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
<result> = sub nsw <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
<result> = sub nuw nsw <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
Overview:¶
The ‘sub
‘ instruction returns the difference of its two operands.
Note that the ‘sub
‘ instruction is used to represent the ‘neg
‘
instruction present in most other intermediate representations.
Arguments:¶
The two arguments to the ‘sub
‘ instruction must be
integer or vector of integer values. Both
arguments must have identical types.
Semantics:¶
The value produced is the integer difference of the two operands.
If the difference has unsigned overflow, the result returned is the mathematical result modulo 2n, where n is the bit width of the result.
Because LLVM integers use a two’s complement representation, this instruction is appropriate for both signed and unsigned integers.
nuw
and nsw
stand for “No Unsigned Wrap” and “No Signed Wrap”,
respectively. If the nuw
and/or nsw
keywords are present, the
result value of the sub
is a poison value if
unsigned and/or signed overflow, respectively, occurs.
‘fsub
‘ Instruction¶
Overview:¶
The ‘fsub
‘ instruction returns the difference of its two operands.
Note that the ‘fsub
‘ instruction is used to represent the ‘fneg
‘
instruction present in most other intermediate representations.
Arguments:¶
The two arguments to the ‘fsub
‘ instruction must be floating
point or vector of floating point values.
Both arguments must have identical types.
Semantics:¶
The value produced is the floating point difference of the two operands. This instruction can also take any number of fast-math flags, which are optimization hints to enable otherwise unsafe floating point optimizations:
‘mul
‘ Instruction¶
Syntax:¶
<result> = mul <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
<result> = mul nuw <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
<result> = mul nsw <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
<result> = mul nuw nsw <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
Arguments:¶
The two arguments to the ‘mul
‘ instruction must be
integer or vector of integer values. Both
arguments must have identical types.
Semantics:¶
The value produced is the integer product of the two operands.
If the result of the multiplication has unsigned overflow, the result returned is the mathematical result modulo 2n, where n is the bit width of the result.
Because LLVM integers use a two’s complement representation, and the
result is the same width as the operands, this instruction returns the
correct result for both signed and unsigned integers. If a full product
(e.g. i32
* i32
-> i64
) is needed, the operands should be
sign-extended or zero-extended as appropriate to the width of the full
product.
nuw
and nsw
stand for “No Unsigned Wrap” and “No Signed Wrap”,
respectively. If the nuw
and/or nsw
keywords are present, the
result value of the mul
is a poison value if
unsigned and/or signed overflow, respectively, occurs.
‘fmul
‘ Instruction¶
Arguments:¶
The two arguments to the ‘fmul
‘ instruction must be floating
point or vector of floating point values.
Both arguments must have identical types.
Semantics:¶
The value produced is the floating point product of the two operands. This instruction can also take any number of fast-math flags, which are optimization hints to enable otherwise unsafe floating point optimizations:
‘udiv
‘ Instruction¶
Syntax:¶
<result> = udiv <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
<result> = udiv exact <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
Arguments:¶
The two arguments to the ‘udiv
‘ instruction must be
integer or vector of integer values. Both
arguments must have identical types.
Semantics:¶
The value produced is the unsigned integer quotient of the two operands.
Note that unsigned integer division and signed integer division are
distinct operations; for signed integer division, use ‘sdiv
‘.
Division by zero leads to undefined behavior.
If the exact
keyword is present, the result value of the udiv
is
a poison value if %op1 is not a multiple of %op2 (as
such, “((a udiv exact b) mul b) == a”).
‘sdiv
‘ Instruction¶
Syntax:¶
<result> = sdiv <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
<result> = sdiv exact <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
Arguments:¶
The two arguments to the ‘sdiv
‘ instruction must be
integer or vector of integer values. Both
arguments must have identical types.
Semantics:¶
The value produced is the signed integer quotient of the two operands rounded towards zero.
Note that signed integer division and unsigned integer division are
distinct operations; for unsigned integer division, use ‘udiv
‘.
Division by zero leads to undefined behavior. Overflow also leads to undefined behavior; this is a rare case, but can occur, for example, by doing a 32-bit division of -2147483648 by -1.
If the exact
keyword is present, the result value of the sdiv
is
a poison value if the result would be rounded.
‘fdiv
‘ Instruction¶
Arguments:¶
The two arguments to the ‘fdiv
‘ instruction must be floating
point or vector of floating point values.
Both arguments must have identical types.
Semantics:¶
The value produced is the floating point quotient of the two operands. This instruction can also take any number of fast-math flags, which are optimization hints to enable otherwise unsafe floating point optimizations:
‘urem
‘ Instruction¶
Overview:¶
The ‘urem
‘ instruction returns the remainder from the unsigned
division of its two arguments.
Arguments:¶
The two arguments to the ‘urem
‘ instruction must be
integer or vector of integer values. Both
arguments must have identical types.
Semantics:¶
This instruction returns the unsigned integer remainder of a division. This instruction always performs an unsigned division to get the remainder.
Note that unsigned integer remainder and signed integer remainder are
distinct operations; for signed integer remainder, use ‘srem
‘.
Taking the remainder of a division by zero leads to undefined behavior.
‘srem
‘ Instruction¶
Overview:¶
The ‘srem
‘ instruction returns the remainder from the signed
division of its two operands. This instruction can also take
vector versions of the values in which case the elements
must be integers.
Arguments:¶
The two arguments to the ‘srem
‘ instruction must be
integer or vector of integer values. Both
arguments must have identical types.
Semantics:¶
This instruction returns the remainder of a division (where the result
is either zero or has the same sign as the dividend, op1
), not the
modulo operator (where the result is either zero or has the same sign
as the divisor, op2
) of a value. For more information about the
difference, see The Math
Forum. For a
table of how this is implemented in various languages, please see
Wikipedia: modulo
operation.
Note that signed integer remainder and unsigned integer remainder are
distinct operations; for unsigned integer remainder, use ‘urem
‘.
Taking the remainder of a division by zero leads to undefined behavior. Overflow also leads to undefined behavior; this is a rare case, but can occur, for example, by taking the remainder of a 32-bit division of -2147483648 by -1. (The remainder doesn’t actually overflow, but this rule lets srem be implemented using instructions that return both the result of the division and the remainder.)
‘frem
‘ Instruction¶
Arguments:¶
The two arguments to the ‘frem
‘ instruction must be floating
point or vector of floating point values.
Both arguments must have identical types.
Semantics:¶
This instruction returns the remainder of a division. The remainder has the same sign as the dividend. This instruction can also take any number of fast-math flags, which are optimization hints to enable otherwise unsafe floating point optimizations:
Bitwise Binary Operations¶
Bitwise binary operators are used to do various forms of bit-twiddling in a program. They are generally very efficient instructions and can commonly be strength reduced from other instructions. They require two operands of the same type, execute an operation on them, and produce a single value. The resulting value is the same type as its operands.
‘shl
‘ Instruction¶
Syntax:¶
<result> = shl <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
<result> = shl nuw <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
<result> = shl nsw <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
<result> = shl nuw nsw <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
Overview:¶
The ‘shl
‘ instruction returns the first operand shifted to the left
a specified number of bits.
Arguments:¶
Both arguments to the ‘shl
‘ instruction must be the same
integer or vector of integer type.
‘op2
‘ is treated as an unsigned value.
Semantics:¶
The value produced is op1
* 2op2 mod 2n,
where n
is the width of the result. If op2
is (statically or
dynamically) equal to or larger than the number of bits in
op1
, the result is undefined. If the arguments are vectors, each
vector element of op1
is shifted by the corresponding shift amount
in op2
.
If the nuw
keyword is present, then the shift produces a poison
value if it shifts out any non-zero bits. If the
nsw
keyword is present, then the shift produces a poison
value if it shifts out any bits that disagree with the
resultant sign bit. As such, NUW/NSW have the same semantics as they
would if the shift were expressed as a mul instruction with the same
nsw/nuw bits in (mul %op1, (shl 1, %op2)).
‘lshr
‘ Instruction¶
Syntax:¶
<result> = lshr <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
<result> = lshr exact <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
Overview:¶
The ‘lshr
‘ instruction (logical shift right) returns the first
operand shifted to the right a specified number of bits with zero fill.
Arguments:¶
Both arguments to the ‘lshr
‘ instruction must be the same
integer or vector of integer type.
‘op2
‘ is treated as an unsigned value.
Semantics:¶
This instruction always performs a logical shift right operation. The
most significant bits of the result will be filled with zero bits after
the shift. If op2
is (statically or dynamically) equal to or larger
than the number of bits in op1
, the result is undefined. If the
arguments are vectors, each vector element of op1
is shifted by the
corresponding shift amount in op2
.
If the exact
keyword is present, the result value of the lshr
is
a poison value if any of the bits shifted out are
non-zero.
Example:¶
<result> = lshr i32 4, 1 ; yields i32:result = 2
<result> = lshr i32 4, 2 ; yields i32:result = 1
<result> = lshr i8 4, 3 ; yields i8:result = 0
<result> = lshr i8 -2, 1 ; yields i8:result = 0x7F
<result> = lshr i32 1, 32 ; undefined
<result> = lshr <2 x i32> < i32 -2, i32 4>, < i32 1, i32 2> ; yields: result=<2 x i32> < i32 0x7FFFFFFF, i32 1>
‘ashr
‘ Instruction¶
Syntax:¶
<result> = ashr <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
<result> = ashr exact <ty> <op1>, <op2> ; yields ty:result
Overview:¶
The ‘ashr
‘ instruction (arithmetic shift right) returns the first
operand shifted to the right a specified number of bits with sign
extension.
Arguments:¶
Both arguments to the ‘ashr
‘ instruction must be the same
integer or vector of integer type.
‘op2
‘ is treated as an unsigned value.
Semantics:¶
This instruction always performs an arithmetic shift right operation,
The most significant bits of the result will be filled with the sign bit
of op1
. If op2
is (statically or dynamically) equal to or larger
than the number of bits in op1
, the result is undefined. If the
arguments are vectors, each vector element of op1
is shifted by the
corresponding shift amount in op2
.
If the exact
keyword is present, the result value of the ashr
is
a poison value if any of the bits shifted out are
non-zero.
Example:¶
<result> = ashr i32 4, 1 ; yields i32:result = 2
<result> = ashr i32 4, 2 ; yields i32:result = 1
<result> = ashr i8 4, 3 ; yields i8:result = 0
<result> = ashr i8 -2, 1 ; yields i8:result = -1
<result> = ashr i32 1, 32 ; undefined
<result> = ashr <2 x i32> < i32 -2, i32 4>, < i32 1, i32 3> ; yields: result=<2 x i32> < i32 -1, i32 0>
‘and
‘ Instruction¶
Arguments:¶
The two arguments to the ‘and
‘ instruction must be
integer or vector of integer values. Both
arguments must have identical types.
‘or
‘ Instruction¶
Arguments:¶
The two arguments to the ‘or
‘ instruction must be
integer or vector of integer values. Both
arguments must have identical types.
‘xor
‘ Instruction¶
Overview:¶
The ‘xor
‘ instruction returns the bitwise logical exclusive or of
its two operands. The xor
is used to implement the “one’s
complement” operation, which is the “~” operator in C.
Arguments:¶
The two arguments to the ‘xor
‘ instruction must be
integer or vector of integer values. Both
arguments must have identical types.
Vector Operations¶
LLVM supports several instructions to represent vector operations in a target-independent manner. These instructions cover the element-access and vector-specific operations needed to process vectors effectively. While LLVM does directly support these vector operations, many sophisticated algorithms will want to use target-specific intrinsics to take full advantage of a specific target.
‘extractelement
‘ Instruction¶
Overview:¶
The ‘extractelement
‘ instruction extracts a single scalar element
from a vector at a specified index.
Arguments:¶
The first operand of an ‘extractelement
‘ instruction is a value of
vector type. The second operand is an index indicating
the position from which to extract the element. The index may be a
variable of any integer type.
Semantics:¶
The result is a scalar of the same type as the element type of val
.
Its value is the value at position idx
of val
. If idx
exceeds the length of val
, the results are undefined.
‘insertelement
‘ Instruction¶
Overview:¶
The ‘insertelement
‘ instruction inserts a scalar element into a
vector at a specified index.
Arguments:¶
The first operand of an ‘insertelement
‘ instruction is a value of
vector type. The second operand is a scalar value whose
type must equal the element type of the first operand. The third operand
is an index indicating the position at which to insert the value. The
index may be a variable of any integer type.
Semantics:¶
The result is a vector of the same type as val
. Its element values
are those of val
except at position idx
, where it gets the value
elt
. If idx
exceeds the length of val
, the results are
undefined.
‘shufflevector
‘ Instruction¶
Syntax:¶
<result> = shufflevector <n x <ty>> <v1>, <n x <ty>> <v2>, <m x i32> <mask> ; yields <m x <ty>>
Overview:¶
The ‘shufflevector
‘ instruction constructs a permutation of elements
from two input vectors, returning a vector with the same element type as
the input and length that is the same as the shuffle mask.
Arguments:¶
The first two operands of a ‘shufflevector
‘ instruction are vectors
with the same type. The third argument is a shuffle mask whose element
type is always ‘i32’. The result of the instruction is a vector whose
length is the same as the shuffle mask and whose element type is the
same as the element type of the first two operands.
The shuffle mask operand is required to be a constant vector with either constant integer or undef values.
Semantics:¶
The elements of the two input vectors are numbered from left to right across both of the vectors. The shuffle mask operand specifies, for each element of the result vector, which element of the two input vectors the result element gets. The element selector may be undef (meaning “don’t care”) and the second operand may be undef if performing a shuffle from only one vector.
Example:¶
<result> = shufflevector <4 x i32> %v1, <4 x i32> %v2,
<4 x i32> <i32 0, i32 4, i32 1, i32 5> ; yields <4 x i32>
<result> = shufflevector <4 x i32> %v1, <4 x i32> undef,
<4 x i32> <i32 0, i32 1, i32 2, i32 3> ; yields <4 x i32> - Identity shuffle.
<result> = shufflevector <8 x i32> %v1, <8 x i32> undef,
<4 x i32> <i32 0, i32 1, i32 2, i32 3> ; yields <4 x i32>
<result> = shufflevector <4 x i32> %v1, <4 x i32> %v2,
<8 x i32> <i32 0, i32 1, i32 2, i32 3, i32 4, i32 5, i32 6, i32 7 > ; yields <8 x i32>
Aggregate Operations¶
LLVM supports several instructions for working with aggregate values.
‘extractvalue
‘ Instruction¶
Overview:¶
The ‘extractvalue
‘ instruction extracts the value of a member field
from an aggregate value.
Arguments:¶
The first operand of an ‘extractvalue
‘ instruction is a value of
struct or array type. The other operands are
constant indices to specify which value to extract in a similar manner
as indices in a ‘getelementptr
‘ instruction.
The major differences to getelementptr
indexing are:
- Since the value being indexed is not a pointer, the first index is omitted and assumed to be zero.
- At least one index must be specified.
- Not only struct indices but also array indices must be in bounds.
Semantics:¶
The result is the value at the position in the aggregate specified by the index operands.
‘insertvalue
‘ Instruction¶
Syntax:¶
<result> = insertvalue <aggregate type> <val>, <ty> <elt>, <idx>{, <idx>}* ; yields <aggregate type>
Arguments:¶
The first operand of an ‘insertvalue
‘ instruction is a value of
struct or array type. The second operand is
a first-class value to insert. The following operands are constant
indices indicating the position at which to insert the value in a
similar manner as indices in a ‘extractvalue
‘ instruction. The value
to insert must have the same type as the value identified by the
indices.
Semantics:¶
The result is an aggregate of the same type as val
. Its value is
that of val
except that the value at the position specified by the
indices is that of elt
.
Memory Access and Addressing Operations¶
A key design point of an SSA-based representation is how it represents memory. In LLVM, no memory locations are in SSA form, which makes things very simple. This section describes how to read, write, and allocate memory in LLVM.
‘alloca
‘ Instruction¶
Syntax:¶
<result> = alloca [inalloca] <type> [, <ty> <NumElements>] [, align <alignment>] ; yields type*:result
Overview:¶
The ‘alloca
‘ instruction allocates memory on the stack frame of the
currently executing function, to be automatically released when this
function returns to its caller. The object is always allocated in the
generic address space (address space zero).
Arguments:¶
The ‘alloca
‘ instruction allocates sizeof(<type>)*NumElements
bytes of memory on the runtime stack, returning a pointer of the
appropriate type to the program. If “NumElements” is specified, it is
the number of elements allocated, otherwise “NumElements” is defaulted
to be one. If a constant alignment is specified, the value result of the
allocation is guaranteed to be aligned to at least that boundary. The
alignment may not be greater than 1 << 29
. If not specified, or if
zero, the target can choose to align the allocation on any convenient
boundary compatible with the type.
‘type
‘ may be any sized type.
Semantics:¶
Memory is allocated; a pointer is returned. The operation is undefined
if there is insufficient stack space for the allocation. ‘alloca
‘d
memory is automatically released when the function returns. The
‘alloca
‘ instruction is commonly used to represent automatic
variables that must have an address available. When the function returns
(either with the ret
or resume
instructions), the memory is
reclaimed. Allocating zero bytes is legal, but the result is undefined.
The order in which memory is allocated (ie., which way the stack grows)
is not specified.
‘load
‘ Instruction¶
Syntax:¶
<result> = load [volatile] <ty>, <ty>* <pointer>[, align <alignment>][, !nontemporal !<index>][, !invariant.load !<index>][, !invariant.group !<index>][, !nonnull !<index>][, !dereferenceable !<deref_bytes_node>][, !dereferenceable_or_null !<deref_bytes_node>][, !align !<align_node>]
<result> = load atomic [volatile] <ty>* <pointer> [singlethread] <ordering>, align <alignment> [, !invariant.group !<index>]
!<index> = !{ i32 1 }
!<deref_bytes_node> = !{i64 <dereferenceable_bytes>}
!<align_node> = !{ i64 <value_alignment> }
Arguments:¶
The argument to the load
instruction specifies the memory address
from which to load. The type specified must be a first
class type. If the load
is marked as volatile
,
then the optimizer is not allowed to modify the number or order of
execution of this load
with other volatile
operations.
If the load
is marked as atomic
, it takes an extra ordering and optional singlethread
argument. The release
and
acq_rel
orderings are not valid on load
instructions. Atomic loads
produce defined results when they may see multiple atomic
stores. The type of the pointee must be an integer, pointer, or floating-point
type whose bit width is a power of two greater than or equal to eight and less
than or equal to a target-specific size limit. align
must be explicitly
specified on atomic loads, and the load has undefined behavior if the alignment
is not set to a value which is at least the size in bytes of the
pointee. !nontemporal
does not have any defined semantics for atomic loads.
The optional constant align
argument specifies the alignment of the
operation (that is, the alignment of the memory address). A value of 0
or an omitted align
argument means that the operation has the ABI
alignment for the target. It is the responsibility of the code emitter
to ensure that the alignment information is correct. Overestimating the
alignment results in undefined behavior. Underestimating the alignment
may produce less efficient code. An alignment of 1 is always safe. The
maximum possible alignment is 1 << 29
.
The optional !nontemporal
metadata must reference a single
metadata name <index>
corresponding to a metadata node with one
i32
entry of value 1. The existence of the !nontemporal
metadata on the instruction tells the optimizer and code generator
that this load is not expected to be reused in the cache. The code
generator may select special instructions to save cache bandwidth, such
as the MOVNT
instruction on x86.
The optional !invariant.load
metadata must reference a single
metadata name <index>
corresponding to a metadata node with no
entries. The existence of the !invariant.load
metadata on the
instruction tells the optimizer and code generator that the address
operand to this load points to memory which can be assumed unchanged.
Being invariant does not imply that a location is dereferenceable,
but it does imply that once the location is known dereferenceable
its value is henceforth unchanging.
- The optional
!invariant.group
metadata must reference a single metadata name <index>
corresponding to a metadata node. Seeinvariant.group
metadata.
The optional !nonnull
metadata must reference a single
metadata name <index>
corresponding to a metadata node with no
entries. The existence of the !nonnull
metadata on the
instruction tells the optimizer that the value loaded is known to
never be null. This is analogous to the nonnull
attribute
on parameters and return values. This metadata can only be applied
to loads of a pointer type.
The optional !dereferenceable
metadata must reference a single metadata
name <deref_bytes_node>
corresponding to a metadata node with one i64
entry. The existence of the !dereferenceable
metadata on the instruction
tells the optimizer that the value loaded is known to be dereferenceable.
The number of bytes known to be dereferenceable is specified by the integer
value in the metadata node. This is analogous to the ‘’dereferenceable’’
attribute on parameters and return values. This metadata can only be applied
to loads of a pointer type.
The optional !dereferenceable_or_null
metadata must reference a single
metadata name <deref_bytes_node>
corresponding to a metadata node with one
i64
entry. The existence of the !dereferenceable_or_null
metadata on the
instruction tells the optimizer that the value loaded is known to be either
dereferenceable or null.
The number of bytes known to be dereferenceable is specified by the integer
value in the metadata node. This is analogous to the ‘’dereferenceable_or_null’’
attribute on parameters and return values. This metadata can only be applied
to loads of a pointer type.
The optional !align
metadata must reference a single metadata name
<align_node>
corresponding to a metadata node with one i64
entry.
The existence of the !align
metadata on the instruction tells the
optimizer that the value loaded is known to be aligned to a boundary specified
by the integer value in the metadata node. The alignment must be a power of 2.
This is analogous to the ‘’align’’ attribute on parameters and return values.
This metadata can only be applied to loads of a pointer type.
Semantics:¶
The location of memory pointed to is loaded. If the value being loaded
is of scalar type then the number of bytes read does not exceed the
minimum number of bytes needed to hold all bits of the type. For
example, loading an i24
reads at most three bytes. When loading a
value of a type like i20
with a size that is not an integral number
of bytes, the result is undefined if the value was not originally
written using a store of the same type.
‘store
‘ Instruction¶
Syntax:¶
store [volatile] <ty> <value>, <ty>* <pointer>[, align <alignment>][, !nontemporal !<index>][, !invariant.group !<index>] ; yields void
store atomic [volatile] <ty> <value>, <ty>* <pointer> [singlethread] <ordering>, align <alignment> [, !invariant.group !<index>] ; yields void
Arguments:¶
There are two arguments to the store
instruction: a value to store
and an address at which to store it. The type of the <pointer>
operand must be a pointer to the first class type of
the <value>
operand. If the store
is marked as volatile
,
then the optimizer is not allowed to modify the number or order of
execution of this store
with other volatile
operations.
If the store
is marked as atomic
, it takes an extra ordering and optional singlethread
argument. The acquire
and
acq_rel
orderings aren’t valid on store
instructions. Atomic loads
produce defined results when they may see multiple atomic
stores. The type of the pointee must be an integer, pointer, or floating-point
type whose bit width is a power of two greater than or equal to eight and less
than or equal to a target-specific size limit. align
must be explicitly
specified on atomic stores, and the store has undefined behavior if the
alignment is not set to a value which is at least the size in bytes of the
pointee. !nontemporal
does not have any defined semantics for atomic stores.
The optional constant align
argument specifies the alignment of the
operation (that is, the alignment of the memory address). A value of 0
or an omitted align
argument means that the operation has the ABI
alignment for the target. It is the responsibility of the code emitter
to ensure that the alignment information is correct. Overestimating the
alignment results in undefined behavior. Underestimating the
alignment may produce less efficient code. An alignment of 1 is always
safe. The maximum possible alignment is 1 << 29
.
The optional !nontemporal
metadata must reference a single metadata
name <index>
corresponding to a metadata node with one i32
entry of
value 1. The existence of the !nontemporal
metadata on the instruction
tells the optimizer and code generator that this load is not expected to
be reused in the cache. The code generator may select special
instructions to save cache bandwidth, such as the MOVNT
instruction on
x86.
The optional !invariant.group
metadata must reference a
single metadata name <index>
. See invariant.group
metadata.
Semantics:¶
The contents of memory are updated to contain <value>
at the
location specified by the <pointer>
operand. If <value>
is
of scalar type then the number of bytes written does not exceed the
minimum number of bytes needed to hold all bits of the type. For
example, storing an i24
writes at most three bytes. When writing a
value of a type like i20
with a size that is not an integral number
of bytes, it is unspecified what happens to the extra bits that do not
belong to the type, but they will typically be overwritten.
‘fence
‘ Instruction¶
Arguments:¶
‘fence
‘ instructions take an ordering argument which
defines what synchronizes-with edges they add. They can only be given
acquire
, release
, acq_rel
, and seq_cst
orderings.
Semantics:¶
A fence A which has (at least) release
ordering semantics
synchronizes with a fence B with (at least) acquire
ordering
semantics if and only if there exist atomic operations X and Y, both
operating on some atomic object M, such that A is sequenced before X, X
modifies M (either directly or through some side effect of a sequence
headed by X), Y is sequenced before B, and Y observes M. This provides a
happens-before dependency between A and B. Rather than an explicit
fence
, one (but not both) of the atomic operations X or Y might
provide a release
or acquire
(resp.) ordering constraint and
still synchronize-with the explicit fence
and establish the
happens-before edge.
A fence
which has seq_cst
ordering, in addition to having both
acquire
and release
semantics specified above, participates in
the global program order of other seq_cst
operations and/or fences.
The optional “singlethread” argument specifies that the fence only synchronizes with other fences in the same thread. (This is useful for interacting with signal handlers.)
‘cmpxchg
‘ Instruction¶
Syntax:¶
cmpxchg [weak] [volatile] <ty>* <pointer>, <ty> <cmp>, <ty> <new> [singlethread] <success ordering> <failure ordering> ; yields { ty, i1 }
Overview:¶
The ‘cmpxchg
‘ instruction is used to atomically modify memory. It
loads a value in memory and compares it to a given value. If they are
equal, it tries to store a new value into the memory.
Arguments:¶
There are three arguments to the ‘cmpxchg
‘ instruction: an address
to operate on, a value to compare to the value currently be at that
address, and a new value to place at that address if the compared values
are equal. The type of ‘<cmp>’ must be an integer or pointer type whose
bit width is a power of two greater than or equal to eight and less
than or equal to a target-specific size limit. ‘<cmp>’ and ‘<new>’ must
have the same type, and the type of ‘<pointer>’ must be a pointer to
that type. If the cmpxchg
is marked as volatile
, then the
optimizer is not allowed to modify the number or order of execution of
this cmpxchg
with other volatile operations.
The success and failure ordering arguments specify how this
cmpxchg
synchronizes with other atomic operations. Both ordering parameters
must be at least monotonic
, the ordering constraint on failure must be no
stronger than that on success, and the failure ordering cannot be either
release
or acq_rel
.
The optional “singlethread
” argument declares that the cmpxchg
is only atomic with respect to code (usually signal handlers) running in
the same thread as the cmpxchg
. Otherwise the cmpxchg is atomic with
respect to all other code in the system.
The pointer passed into cmpxchg must have alignment greater than or equal to the size in memory of the operand.
Semantics:¶
The contents of memory at the location specified by the ‘<pointer>
‘ operand
is read and compared to ‘<cmp>
‘; if the read value is the equal, the
‘<new>
‘ is written. The original value at the location is returned, together
with a flag indicating success (true) or failure (false).
If the cmpxchg operation is marked as weak
then a spurious failure is
permitted: the operation may not write <new>
even if the comparison
matched.
If the cmpxchg operation is strong (the default), the i1 value is 1 if and only
if the value loaded equals cmp
.
A successful cmpxchg
is a read-modify-write instruction for the purpose of
identifying release sequences. A failed cmpxchg
is equivalent to an atomic
load with an ordering parameter determined the second ordering parameter.
Example:¶
entry:
%orig = load atomic i32, i32* %ptr unordered, align 4 ; yields i32
br label %loop
loop:
%cmp = phi i32 [ %orig, %entry ], [%value_loaded, %loop]
%squared = mul i32 %cmp, %cmp
%val_success = cmpxchg i32* %ptr, i32 %cmp, i32 %squared acq_rel monotonic ; yields { i32, i1 }
%value_loaded = extractvalue { i32, i1 } %val_success, 0
%success = extractvalue { i32, i1 } %val_success, 1
br i1 %success, label %done, label %loop
done:
...
‘atomicrmw
‘ Instruction¶
Syntax:¶
atomicrmw [volatile] <operation> <ty>* <pointer>, <ty> <value> [singlethread] <ordering> ; yields ty
Arguments:¶
There are three arguments to the ‘atomicrmw
‘ instruction: an
operation to apply, an address whose value to modify, an argument to the
operation. The operation must be one of the following keywords:
- xchg
- add
- sub
- and
- nand
- or
- xor
- max
- min
- umax
- umin
The type of ‘<value>’ must be an integer type whose bit width is a power
of two greater than or equal to eight and less than or equal to a
target-specific size limit. The type of the ‘<pointer>
‘ operand must
be a pointer to that type. If the atomicrmw
is marked as
volatile
, then the optimizer is not allowed to modify the number or
order of execution of this atomicrmw
with other volatile
operations.
Semantics:¶
The contents of memory at the location specified by the ‘<pointer>
‘
operand are atomically read, modified, and written back. The original
value at the location is returned. The modification is specified by the
operation argument:
- xchg:
*ptr = val
- add:
*ptr = *ptr + val
- sub:
*ptr = *ptr - val
- and:
*ptr = *ptr & val
- nand:
*ptr = ~(*ptr & val)
- or:
*ptr = *ptr | val
- xor:
*ptr = *ptr ^ val
- max:
*ptr = *ptr > val ? *ptr : val
(using a signed comparison) - min:
*ptr = *ptr < val ? *ptr : val
(using a signed comparison) - umax:
*ptr = *ptr > val ? *ptr : val
(using an unsigned comparison) - umin:
*ptr = *ptr < val ? *ptr : val
(using an unsigned comparison)
‘getelementptr
‘ Instruction¶
Syntax:¶
<result> = getelementptr <ty>, <ty>* <ptrval>{, <ty> <idx>}*
<result> = getelementptr inbounds <ty>, <ty>* <ptrval>{, <ty> <idx>}*
<result> = getelementptr <ty>, <ptr vector> <ptrval>, <vector index type> <idx>
Overview:¶
The ‘getelementptr
‘ instruction is used to get the address of a
subelement of an aggregate data structure. It performs
address calculation only and does not access memory. The instruction can also
be used to calculate a vector of such addresses.
Arguments:¶
The first argument is always a type used as the basis for the calculations. The second argument is always a pointer or a vector of pointers, and is the base address to start from. The remaining arguments are indices that indicate which of the elements of the aggregate object are indexed. The interpretation of each index is dependent on the type being indexed into. The first index always indexes the pointer value given as the first argument, the second index indexes a value of the type pointed to (not necessarily the value directly pointed to, since the first index can be non-zero), etc. The first type indexed into must be a pointer value, subsequent types can be arrays, vectors, and structs. Note that subsequent types being indexed into can never be pointers, since that would require loading the pointer before continuing calculation.
The type of each index argument depends on the type it is indexing into.
When indexing into a (optionally packed) structure, only i32
integer
constants are allowed (when using a vector of indices they must all
be the same i32
integer constant). When indexing into an array,
pointer or vector, integers of any width are allowed, and they are not
required to be constant. These integers are treated as signed values
where relevant.
For example, let’s consider a C code fragment and how it gets compiled to LLVM:
struct RT {
char A;
int B[10][20];
char C;
};
struct ST {
int X;
double Y;
struct RT Z;
};
int *foo(struct ST *s) {
return &s[1].Z.B[5][13];
}
The LLVM code generated by Clang is:
%struct.RT = type { i8, [10 x [20 x i32]], i8 }
%struct.ST = type { i32, double, %struct.RT }
define i32* @foo(%struct.ST* %s) nounwind uwtable readnone optsize ssp {
entry:
%arrayidx = getelementptr inbounds %struct.ST, %struct.ST* %s, i64 1, i32 2, i32 1, i64 5, i64 13
ret i32* %arrayidx
}
Semantics:¶
In the example above, the first index is indexing into the
‘%struct.ST*
‘ type, which is a pointer, yielding a ‘%struct.ST
‘
= ‘{ i32, double, %struct.RT }
‘ type, a structure. The second index
indexes into the third element of the structure, yielding a
‘%struct.RT
‘ = ‘{ i8 , [10 x [20 x i32]], i8 }
‘ type, another
structure. The third index indexes into the second element of the
structure, yielding a ‘[10 x [20 x i32]]
‘ type, an array. The two
dimensions of the array are subscripted into, yielding an ‘i32
‘
type. The ‘getelementptr
‘ instruction returns a pointer to this
element, thus computing a value of ‘i32*
‘ type.
Note that it is perfectly legal to index partially through a structure, returning a pointer to an inner element. Because of this, the LLVM code for the given testcase is equivalent to:
define i32* @foo(%struct.ST* %s) {
%t1 = getelementptr %struct.ST, %struct.ST* %s, i32 1 ; yields %struct.ST*:%t1
%t2 = getelementptr %struct.ST, %struct.ST* %t1, i32 0, i32 2 ; yields %struct.RT*:%t2
%t3 = getelementptr %struct.RT, %struct.RT* %t2, i32 0, i32 1 ; yields [10 x [20 x i32]]*:%t3
%t4 = getelementptr [10 x [20 x i32]], [10 x [20 x i32]]* %t3, i32 0, i32 5 ; yields [20 x i32]*:%t4
%t5 = getelementptr [20 x i32], [20 x i32]* %t4, i32 0, i32 13 ; yields i32*:%t5
ret i32* %t5
}
If the inbounds
keyword is present, the result value of the
getelementptr
is a poison value if the base
pointer is not an in bounds address of an allocated object, or if any
of the addresses that would be formed by successive addition of the
offsets implied by the indices to the base address with infinitely
precise signed arithmetic are not an in bounds address of that
allocated object. The in bounds addresses for an allocated object are
all the addresses that point into the object, plus the address one byte
past the end. In cases where the base is a vector of pointers the
inbounds
keyword applies to each of the computations element-wise.
If the inbounds
keyword is not present, the offsets are added to the
base address with silently-wrapping two’s complement arithmetic. If the
offsets have a different width from the pointer, they are sign-extended
or truncated to the width of the pointer. The result value of the
getelementptr
may be outside the object pointed to by the base
pointer. The result value may not necessarily be used to access memory
though, even if it happens to point into allocated storage. See the
Pointer Aliasing Rules section for more
information.
The getelementptr instruction is often confusing. For some more insight into how it works, see the getelementptr FAQ.
Example:¶
; yields [12 x i8]*:aptr
%aptr = getelementptr {i32, [12 x i8]}, {i32, [12 x i8]}* %saptr, i64 0, i32 1
; yields i8*:vptr
%vptr = getelementptr {i32, <2 x i8>}, {i32, <2 x i8>}* %svptr, i64 0, i32 1, i32 1
; yields i8*:eptr
%eptr = getelementptr [12 x i8], [12 x i8]* %aptr, i64 0, i32 1
; yields i32*:iptr
%iptr = getelementptr [10 x i32], [10 x i32]* @arr, i16 0, i16 0
Vector of pointers:¶
The getelementptr
returns a vector of pointers, instead of a single address,
when one or more of its arguments is a vector. In such cases, all vector
arguments should have the same number of elements, and every scalar argument
will be effectively broadcast into a vector during address calculation.
; All arguments are vectors:
; A[i] = ptrs[i] + offsets[i]*sizeof(i8)
%A = getelementptr i8, <4 x i8*> %ptrs, <4 x i64> %offsets
; Add the same scalar offset to each pointer of a vector:
; A[i] = ptrs[i] + offset*sizeof(i8)
%A = getelementptr i8, <4 x i8*> %ptrs, i64 %offset
; Add distinct offsets to the same pointer:
; A[i] = ptr + offsets[i]*sizeof(i8)
%A = getelementptr i8, i8* %ptr, <4 x i64> %offsets
; In all cases described above the type of the result is <4 x i8*>
The two following instructions are equivalent:
getelementptr %struct.ST, <4 x %struct.ST*> %s, <4 x i64> %ind1,
<4 x i32> <i32 2, i32 2, i32 2, i32 2>,
<4 x i32> <i32 1, i32 1, i32 1, i32 1>,
<4 x i32> %ind4,
<4 x i64> <i64 13, i64 13, i64 13, i64 13>
getelementptr %struct.ST, <4 x %struct.ST*> %s, <4 x i64> %ind1,
i32 2, i32 1, <4 x i32> %ind4, i64 13
Let’s look at the C code, where the vector version of getelementptr
makes sense:
// Let's assume that we vectorize the following loop:
double *A, B; int *C;
for (int i = 0; i < size; ++i) {
A[i] = B[C[i]];
}
; get pointers for 8 elements from array B
%ptrs = getelementptr double, double* %B, <8 x i32> %C
; load 8 elements from array B into A
%A = call <8 x double> @llvm.masked.gather.v8f64(<8 x double*> %ptrs,
i32 8, <8 x i1> %mask, <8 x double> %passthru)
Conversion Operations¶
The instructions in this category are the conversion instructions (casting) which all take a single operand and a type. They perform various bit conversions on the operand.
‘trunc .. to
‘ Instruction¶
Arguments:¶
The ‘trunc
‘ instruction takes a value to trunc, and a type to trunc
it to. Both types must be of integer types, or vectors
of the same number of integers. The bit size of the value
must be
larger than the bit size of the destination type, ty2
. Equal sized
types are not allowed.
Semantics:¶
The ‘trunc
‘ instruction truncates the high order bits in value
and converts the remaining bits to ty2
. Since the source size must
be larger than the destination size, trunc
cannot be a no-op cast.
It will always truncate bits.
‘zext .. to
‘ Instruction¶
Arguments:¶
The ‘zext
‘ instruction takes a value to cast, and a type to cast it
to. Both types must be of integer types, or vectors of
the same number of integers. The bit size of the value
must be
smaller than the bit size of the destination type, ty2
.
Semantics:¶
The zext
fills the high order bits of the value
with zero bits
until it reaches the size of the destination type, ty2
.
When zero extending from i1, the result will always be either 0 or 1.
‘sext .. to
‘ Instruction¶
Arguments:¶
The ‘sext
‘ instruction takes a value to cast, and a type to cast it
to. Both types must be of integer types, or vectors of
the same number of integers. The bit size of the value
must be
smaller than the bit size of the destination type, ty2
.
Semantics:¶
The ‘sext
‘ instruction performs a sign extension by copying the sign
bit (highest order bit) of the value
until it reaches the bit size
of the type ty2
.
When sign extending from i1, the extension always results in -1 or 0.
‘fptrunc .. to
‘ Instruction¶
Arguments:¶
The ‘fptrunc
‘ instruction takes a floating point
value to cast and a floating point type to cast it to.
The size of value
must be larger than the size of ty2
. This
implies that fptrunc
cannot be used to make a no-op cast.
Semantics:¶
The ‘fptrunc
‘ instruction casts a value
from a larger
floating point type to a smaller floating
point type. If the value cannot fit (i.e. overflows) within the
destination type, ty2
, then the results are undefined. If the cast produces
an inexact result, how rounding is performed (e.g. truncation, also known as
round to zero) is undefined.
‘fpext .. to
‘ Instruction¶
Arguments:¶
The ‘fpext
‘ instruction takes a floating point
value
to cast, and a floating point type to cast it
to. The source type must be smaller than the destination type.
Semantics:¶
The ‘fpext
‘ instruction extends the value
from a smaller
floating point type to a larger floating
point type. The fpext
cannot be used to make a
no-op cast because it always changes bits. Use bitcast
to make a
no-op cast for a floating point cast.
‘fptoui .. to
‘ Instruction¶
Overview:¶
The ‘fptoui
‘ converts a floating point value
to its unsigned
integer equivalent of type ty2
.
Arguments:¶
The ‘fptoui
‘ instruction takes a value to cast, which must be a
scalar or vector floating point value, and a type to
cast it to ty2
, which must be an integer type. If
ty
is a vector floating point type, ty2
must be a vector integer
type with the same number of elements as ty
Semantics:¶
The ‘fptoui
‘ instruction converts its floating
point operand into the nearest (rounding towards zero)
unsigned integer value. If the value cannot fit in ty2
, the results
are undefined.
‘fptosi .. to
‘ Instruction¶
Overview:¶
The ‘fptosi
‘ instruction converts floating point
value
to type ty2
.
Arguments:¶
The ‘fptosi
‘ instruction takes a value to cast, which must be a
scalar or vector floating point value, and a type to
cast it to ty2
, which must be an integer type. If
ty
is a vector floating point type, ty2
must be a vector integer
type with the same number of elements as ty
Semantics:¶
The ‘fptosi
‘ instruction converts its floating
point operand into the nearest (rounding towards zero)
signed integer value. If the value cannot fit in ty2
, the results
are undefined.
‘uitofp .. to
‘ Instruction¶
Overview:¶
The ‘uitofp
‘ instruction regards value
as an unsigned integer
and converts that value to the ty2
type.
Arguments:¶
The ‘uitofp
‘ instruction takes a value to cast, which must be a
scalar or vector integer value, and a type to cast it to
ty2
, which must be an floating point type. If
ty
is a vector integer type, ty2
must be a vector floating point
type with the same number of elements as ty
Semantics:¶
The ‘uitofp
‘ instruction interprets its operand as an unsigned
integer quantity and converts it to the corresponding floating point
value. If the value cannot fit in the floating point value, the results
are undefined.
‘sitofp .. to
‘ Instruction¶
Overview:¶
The ‘sitofp
‘ instruction regards value
as a signed integer and
converts that value to the ty2
type.
Arguments:¶
The ‘sitofp
‘ instruction takes a value to cast, which must be a
scalar or vector integer value, and a type to cast it to
ty2
, which must be an floating point type. If
ty
is a vector integer type, ty2
must be a vector floating point
type with the same number of elements as ty
Semantics:¶
The ‘sitofp
‘ instruction interprets its operand as a signed integer
quantity and converts it to the corresponding floating point value. If
the value cannot fit in the floating point value, the results are
undefined.
‘ptrtoint .. to
‘ Instruction¶
Overview:¶
The ‘ptrtoint
‘ instruction converts the pointer or a vector of
pointers value
to the integer (or vector of integers) type ty2
.
Arguments:¶
The ‘ptrtoint
‘ instruction takes a value
to cast, which must be
a value of type pointer or a vector of pointers, and a
type to cast it to ty2
, which must be an integer or
a vector of integers type.
Semantics:¶
The ‘ptrtoint
‘ instruction converts value
to integer type
ty2
by interpreting the pointer value as an integer and either
truncating or zero extending that value to the size of the integer type.
If value
is smaller than ty2
then a zero extension is done. If
value
is larger than ty2
then a truncation is done. If they are
the same size, then nothing is done (no-op cast) other than a type
change.
‘inttoptr .. to
‘ Instruction¶
Arguments:¶
The ‘inttoptr
‘ instruction takes an integer value to
cast, and a type to cast it to, which must be a pointer
type.
Semantics:¶
The ‘inttoptr
‘ instruction converts value
to type ty2
by
applying either a zero extension or a truncation depending on the size
of the integer value
. If value
is larger than the size of a
pointer then a truncation is done. If value
is smaller than the size
of a pointer then a zero extension is done. If they are the same size,
nothing is done (no-op cast).
Example:¶
%X = inttoptr i32 255 to i32* ; yields zero extension on 64-bit architecture
%Y = inttoptr i32 255 to i32* ; yields no-op on 32-bit architecture
%Z = inttoptr i64 0 to i32* ; yields truncation on 32-bit architecture
%Z = inttoptr <4 x i32> %G to <4 x i8*>; yields truncation of vector G to four pointers
‘bitcast .. to
‘ Instruction¶
Arguments:¶
The ‘bitcast
‘ instruction takes a value to cast, which must be a
non-aggregate first class value, and a type to cast it to, which must
also be a non-aggregate first class type. The
bit sizes of value
and the destination type, ty2
, must be
identical. If the source type is a pointer, the destination type must
also be a pointer of the same size. This instruction supports bitwise
conversion of vectors to integers and to vectors of other types (as
long as they have the same size).
Semantics:¶
The ‘bitcast
‘ instruction converts value
to type ty2
. It
is always a no-op cast because no bits change with this
conversion. The conversion is done as if the value
had been stored
to memory and read back as type ty2
. Pointer (or vector of
pointers) types may only be converted to other pointer (or vector of
pointers) types with the same address space through this instruction.
To convert pointers to other types, use the inttoptr
or ptrtoint instructions first.
‘addrspacecast .. to
‘ Instruction¶
Overview:¶
The ‘addrspacecast
‘ instruction converts ptrval
from pty
in
address space n
to type pty2
in address space m
.
Arguments:¶
The ‘addrspacecast
‘ instruction takes a pointer or vector of pointer value
to cast and a pointer type to cast it to, which must have a different
address space.
Semantics:¶
The ‘addrspacecast
‘ instruction converts the pointer value
ptrval
to type pty2
. It can be a no-op cast or a complex
value modification, depending on the target and the address space
pair. Pointer conversions within the same address space must be
performed with the bitcast
instruction. Note that if the address space
conversion is legal then both result and operand refer to the same memory
location.
Other Operations¶
The instructions in this category are the “miscellaneous” instructions, which defy better classification.
‘icmp
‘ Instruction¶
Overview:¶
The ‘icmp
‘ instruction returns a boolean value or a vector of
boolean values based on comparison of its two integer, integer vector,
pointer, or pointer vector operands.
Arguments:¶
The ‘icmp
‘ instruction takes three operands. The first operand is
the condition code indicating the kind of comparison to perform. It is
not a value, just a keyword. The possible condition codes are:
eq
: equalne
: not equalugt
: unsigned greater thanuge
: unsigned greater or equalult
: unsigned less thanule
: unsigned less or equalsgt
: signed greater thansge
: signed greater or equalslt
: signed less thansle
: signed less or equal
The remaining two arguments must be integer or pointer or integer vector typed. They must also be identical types.
Semantics:¶
The ‘icmp
‘ compares op1
and op2
according to the condition
code given as cond
. The comparison performed always yields either an
i1 or vector of i1
result, as follows:
eq
: yieldstrue
if the operands are equal,false
otherwise. No sign interpretation is necessary or performed.ne
: yieldstrue
if the operands are unequal,false
otherwise. No sign interpretation is necessary or performed.ugt
: interprets the operands as unsigned values and yieldstrue
ifop1
is greater thanop2
.uge
: interprets the operands as unsigned values and yieldstrue
ifop1
is greater than or equal toop2
.ult
: interprets the operands as unsigned values and yieldstrue
ifop1
is less thanop2
.ule
: interprets the operands as unsigned values and yieldstrue
ifop1
is less than or equal toop2
.sgt
: interprets the operands as signed values and yieldstrue
ifop1
is greater thanop2
.sge
: interprets the operands as signed values and yieldstrue
ifop1
is greater than or equal toop2
.slt
: interprets the operands as signed values and yieldstrue
ifop1
is less thanop2
.sle
: interprets the operands as signed values and yieldstrue
ifop1
is less than or equal toop2
.
If the operands are pointer typed, the pointer values are compared as if they were integers.
If the operands are integer vectors, then they are compared element by
element. The result is an i1
vector with the same number of elements
as the values being compared. Otherwise, the result is an i1
.
Example:¶
<result> = icmp eq i32 4, 5 ; yields: result=false
<result> = icmp ne float* %X, %X ; yields: result=false
<result> = icmp ult i16 4, 5 ; yields: result=true
<result> = icmp sgt i16 4, 5 ; yields: result=false
<result> = icmp ule i16 -4, 5 ; yields: result=false
<result> = icmp sge i16 4, 5 ; yields: result=false
Note that the code generator does not yet support vector types with the
icmp
instruction.
‘fcmp
‘ Instruction¶
Overview:¶
The ‘fcmp
‘ instruction returns a boolean value or vector of boolean
values based on comparison of its operands.
If the operands are floating point scalars, then the result type is a boolean (i1).
If the operands are floating point vectors, then the result type is a vector of boolean with the same number of elements as the operands being compared.
Arguments:¶
The ‘fcmp
‘ instruction takes three operands. The first operand is
the condition code indicating the kind of comparison to perform. It is
not a value, just a keyword. The possible condition codes are:
false
: no comparison, always returns falseoeq
: ordered and equalogt
: ordered and greater thanoge
: ordered and greater than or equalolt
: ordered and less thanole
: ordered and less than or equalone
: ordered and not equalord
: ordered (no nans)ueq
: unordered or equalugt
: unordered or greater thanuge
: unordered or greater than or equalult
: unordered or less thanule
: unordered or less than or equalune
: unordered or not equaluno
: unordered (either nans)true
: no comparison, always returns true
Ordered means that neither operand is a QNAN while unordered means that either operand may be a QNAN.
Each of val1
and val2
arguments must be either a floating
point type or a vector of floating point
type. They must have identical types.
Semantics:¶
The ‘fcmp
‘ instruction compares op1
and op2
according to the
condition code given as cond
. If the operands are vectors, then the
vectors are compared element by element. Each comparison performed
always yields an i1 result, as follows:
false
: always yieldsfalse
, regardless of operands.oeq
: yieldstrue
if both operands are not a QNAN andop1
is equal toop2
.ogt
: yieldstrue
if both operands are not a QNAN andop1
is greater thanop2
.oge
: yieldstrue
if both operands are not a QNAN andop1
is greater than or equal toop2
.olt
: yieldstrue
if both operands are not a QNAN andop1
is less thanop2
.ole
: yieldstrue
if both operands are not a QNAN andop1
is less than or equal toop2
.one
: yieldstrue
if both operands are not a QNAN andop1
is not equal toop2
.ord
: yieldstrue
if both operands are not a QNAN.ueq
: yieldstrue
if either operand is a QNAN orop1
is equal toop2
.ugt
: yieldstrue
if either operand is a QNAN orop1
is greater thanop2
.uge
: yieldstrue
if either operand is a QNAN orop1
is greater than or equal toop2
.ult
: yieldstrue
if either operand is a QNAN orop1
is less thanop2
.ule
: yieldstrue
if either operand is a QNAN orop1
is less than or equal toop2
.une
: yieldstrue
if either operand is a QNAN orop1
is not equal toop2
.uno
: yieldstrue
if either operand is a QNAN.true
: always yieldstrue
, regardless of operands.
The fcmp
instruction can also optionally take any number of
fast-math flags, which are optimization hints to enable
otherwise unsafe floating point optimizations.
Any set of fast-math flags are legal on an fcmp
instruction, but the
only flags that have any effect on its semantics are those that allow
assumptions to be made about the values of input arguments; namely
nnan
, ninf
, and nsz
. See Fast-Math Flags for more information.
Example:¶
<result> = fcmp oeq float 4.0, 5.0 ; yields: result=false
<result> = fcmp one float 4.0, 5.0 ; yields: result=true
<result> = fcmp olt float 4.0, 5.0 ; yields: result=true
<result> = fcmp ueq double 1.0, 2.0 ; yields: result=false
Note that the code generator does not yet support vector types with the
fcmp
instruction.
‘phi
‘ Instruction¶
Overview:¶
The ‘phi
‘ instruction is used to implement the φ node in the SSA
graph representing the function.
Arguments:¶
The type of the incoming values is specified with the first type field.
After this, the ‘phi
‘ instruction takes a list of pairs as
arguments, with one pair for each predecessor basic block of the current
block. Only values of first class type may be used as
the value arguments to the PHI node. Only labels may be used as the
label arguments.
There must be no non-phi instructions between the start of a basic block and the PHI instructions: i.e. PHI instructions must be first in a basic block.
For the purposes of the SSA form, the use of each incoming value is
deemed to occur on the edge from the corresponding predecessor block to
the current block (but after any definition of an ‘invoke
‘
instruction’s return value on the same edge).
Semantics:¶
At runtime, the ‘phi
‘ instruction logically takes on the value
specified by the pair corresponding to the predecessor basic block that
executed just prior to the current block.
‘select
‘ Instruction¶
Syntax:¶
<result> = select selty <cond>, <ty> <val1>, <ty> <val2> ; yields ty
selty is either i1 or {<N x i1>}
Overview:¶
The ‘select
‘ instruction is used to choose one value based on a
condition, without IR-level branching.
Arguments:¶
The ‘select
‘ instruction requires an ‘i1’ value or a vector of ‘i1’
values indicating the condition, and two values of the same first
class type.
Semantics:¶
If the condition is an i1 and it evaluates to 1, the instruction returns the first value argument; otherwise, it returns the second value argument.
If the condition is a vector of i1, then the value arguments must be vectors of the same size, and the selection is done element by element.
If the condition is an i1 and the value arguments are vectors of the same size, then an entire vector is selected.
‘call
‘ Instruction¶
Syntax:¶
<result> = [tail | musttail | notail ] call [fast-math flags] [cconv] [ret attrs] <ty> [<fnty>*] <fnptrval>(<function args>) [fn attrs]
[ operand bundles ]
Arguments:¶
This instruction requires several arguments:
The optional
tail
andmusttail
markers indicate that the optimizers should perform tail call optimization. Thetail
marker is a hint that can be ignored. Themusttail
marker means that the call must be tail call optimized in order for the program to be correct. Themusttail
marker provides these guarantees:- The call will not cause unbounded stack growth if it is part of a recursive cycle in the call graph.
- Arguments with the inalloca attribute are forwarded in place.
Both markers imply that the callee does not access allocas or varargs from the caller. Calls marked
musttail
must obey the following additional rules:- The call must immediately precede a ret instruction, or a pointer bitcast followed by a ret instruction.
- The ret instruction must return the (possibly bitcasted) value produced by the call or void.
- The caller and callee prototypes must match. Pointer types of parameters or return types may differ in pointee type, but not in address space.
- The calling conventions of the caller and callee must match.
- All ABI-impacting function attributes, such as sret, byval, inreg, returned, and inalloca, must match.
- The callee must be varargs iff the caller is varargs. Bitcasting a non-varargs function to the appropriate varargs type is legal so long as the non-varargs prefixes obey the other rules.
Tail call optimization for calls marked
tail
is guaranteed to occur if the following conditions are met:- Caller and callee both have the calling convention
fastcc
. - The call is in tail position (ret immediately follows call and ret uses value of call or is void).
- Option
-tailcallopt
is enabled, orllvm::GuaranteedTailCallOpt
istrue
. - Platform-specific constraints are met.
The optional
notail
marker indicates that the optimizers should not addtail
ormusttail
markers to the call. It is used to prevent tail call optimization from being performed on the call.The optional
fast-math flags
marker indicates that the call has one or more fast-math flags, which are optimization hints to enable otherwise unsafe floating-point optimizations. Fast-math flags are only valid for calls that return a floating-point scalar or vector type.The optional “cconv” marker indicates which calling convention the call should use. If none is specified, the call defaults to using C calling conventions. The calling convention of the call must match the calling convention of the target function, or else the behavior is undefined.
The optional Parameter Attributes list for return values. Only ‘
zeroext
‘, ‘signext
‘, and ‘inreg
‘ attributes are valid here.‘
ty
‘: the type of the call instruction itself which is also the type of the return value. Functions that return no value are markedvoid
.‘
fnty
‘: shall be the signature of the pointer to function value being invoked. The argument types must match the types implied by this signature. This type can be omitted if the function is not varargs and if the function type does not return a pointer to a function.‘
fnptrval
‘: An LLVM value containing a pointer to a function to be invoked. In most cases, this is a direct function invocation, but indirectcall
‘s are just as possible, calling an arbitrary pointer to function value.‘
function args
‘: argument list whose types match the function signature argument types and parameter attributes. All arguments must be of first class type. If the function signature indicates the function accepts a variable number of arguments, the extra arguments can be specified.The optional function attributes list. Only ‘
noreturn
‘, ‘nounwind
‘, ‘readonly
‘ and ‘readnone
‘ attributes are valid here.The optional operand bundles list.
Semantics:¶
The ‘call
‘ instruction is used to cause control flow to transfer to
a specified function, with its incoming arguments bound to the specified
values. Upon a ‘ret
‘ instruction in the called function, control
flow continues with the instruction after the function call, and the
return value of the function is bound to the result argument.
Example:¶
%retval = call i32 @test(i32 %argc)
call i32 (i8*, ...)* @printf(i8* %msg, i32 12, i8 42) ; yields i32
%X = tail call i32 @foo() ; yields i32
%Y = tail call fastcc i32 @foo() ; yields i32
call void %foo(i8 97 signext)
%struct.A = type { i32, i8 }
%r = call %struct.A @foo() ; yields { i32, i8 }
%gr = extractvalue %struct.A %r, 0 ; yields i32
%gr1 = extractvalue %struct.A %r, 1 ; yields i8
%Z = call void @foo() noreturn ; indicates that %foo never returns normally
%ZZ = call zeroext i32 @bar() ; Return value is %zero extended
llvm treats calls to some functions with names and arguments that match the standard C99 library as being the C99 library functions, and may perform optimizations or generate code for them under that assumption. This is something we’d like to change in the future to provide better support for freestanding environments and non-C-based languages.
‘va_arg
‘ Instruction¶
Overview:¶
The ‘va_arg
‘ instruction is used to access arguments passed through
the “variable argument” area of a function call. It is used to implement
the va_arg
macro in C.
Arguments:¶
This instruction takes a va_list*
value and the type of the
argument. It returns a value of the specified argument type and
increments the va_list
to point to the next argument. The actual
type of va_list
is target specific.
Semantics:¶
The ‘va_arg
‘ instruction loads an argument of the specified type
from the specified va_list
and causes the va_list
to point to
the next argument. For more information, see the variable argument
handling Intrinsic Functions.
It is legal for this instruction to be called in a function which does
not take a variable number of arguments, for example, the vfprintf
function.
va_arg
is an LLVM instruction instead of an intrinsic
function because it takes a type as an argument.
Example:¶
See the variable argument processing section.
Note that the code generator does not yet fully support va_arg on many targets. Also, it does not currently support va_arg with aggregate types on any target.
‘landingpad
‘ Instruction¶
Syntax:¶
<resultval> = landingpad <resultty> <clause>+
<resultval> = landingpad <resultty> cleanup <clause>*
<clause> := catch <type> <value>
<clause> := filter <array constant type> <array constant>
Overview:¶
The ‘landingpad
‘ instruction is used by LLVM’s exception handling
system to specify that a basic block
is a landing pad — one where the exception lands, and corresponds to the
code found in the catch
portion of a try
/catch
sequence. It
defines values supplied by the personality function upon
re-entry to the function. The resultval
has the type resultty
.
Arguments:¶
The optional
cleanup
flag indicates that the landing pad block is a cleanup.
A clause
begins with the clause type — catch
or filter
— and
contains the global variable representing the “type” that may be caught
or filtered respectively. Unlike the catch
clause, the filter
clause takes an array constant as its argument. Use
“[0 x i8**] undef
” for a filter which cannot throw. The
‘landingpad
‘ instruction must contain at least one clause
or
the cleanup
flag.
Semantics:¶
The ‘landingpad
‘ instruction defines the values which are set by the
personality function upon re-entry to the function, and
therefore the “result type” of the landingpad
instruction. As with
calling conventions, how the personality function results are
represented in LLVM IR is target specific.
The clauses are applied in order from top to bottom. If two
landingpad
instructions are merged together through inlining, the
clauses from the calling function are appended to the list of clauses.
When the call stack is being unwound due to an exception being thrown,
the exception is compared against each clause
in turn. If it doesn’t
match any of the clauses, and the cleanup
flag is not set, then
unwinding continues further up the call stack.
The landingpad
instruction has several restrictions:
- A landing pad block is a basic block which is the unwind destination
of an ‘
invoke
‘ instruction. - A landing pad block must have a ‘
landingpad
‘ instruction as its first non-PHI instruction. - There can be only one ‘
landingpad
‘ instruction within the landing pad block. - A basic block that is not a landing pad block may not include a
‘
landingpad
‘ instruction.
Example:¶
;; A landing pad which can catch an integer.
%res = landingpad { i8*, i32 }
catch i8** @_ZTIi
;; A landing pad that is a cleanup.
%res = landingpad { i8*, i32 }
cleanup
;; A landing pad which can catch an integer and can only throw a double.
%res = landingpad { i8*, i32 }
catch i8** @_ZTIi
filter [1 x i8**] [@_ZTId]
‘catchpad
‘ Instruction¶
Overview:¶
The ‘catchpad
‘ instruction is used by LLVM’s exception handling
system to specify that a basic block
begins a catch handler — one where a personality routine attempts to transfer
control to catch an exception.
Arguments:¶
The catchswitch
operand must always be a token produced by a
catchswitch instruction in a predecessor block. This
ensures that each catchpad
has exactly one predecessor block, and it always
terminates in a catchswitch
.
The args
correspond to whatever information the personality routine
requires to know if this is an appropriate handler for the exception. Control
will transfer to the catchpad
if this is the first appropriate handler for
the exception.
The resultval
has the type token and is used to match the
catchpad
to corresponding catchrets and other nested EH
pads.
Semantics:¶
When the call stack is being unwound due to an exception being thrown, the
exception is compared against the args
. If it doesn’t match, control will
not reach the catchpad
instruction. The representation of args
is
entirely target and personality function-specific.
Like the landingpad instruction, the catchpad
instruction must be the first non-phi of its parent basic block.
The meaning of the tokens produced and consumed by catchpad
and other “pad”
instructions is described in the
Windows exception handling documentation.
When a catchpad
has been “entered” but not yet “exited” (as
described in the EH documentation),
it is undefined behavior to execute a call or invoke
that does not carry an appropriate “funclet” bundle.
‘cleanuppad
‘ Instruction¶
Overview:¶
The ‘cleanuppad
‘ instruction is used by LLVM’s exception handling
system to specify that a basic block
is a cleanup block — one where a personality routine attempts to
transfer control to run cleanup actions.
The args
correspond to whatever additional
information the personality function requires to
execute the cleanup.
The resultval
has the type token and is used to
match the cleanuppad
to corresponding cleanuprets.
The parent
argument is the token of the funclet that contains the
cleanuppad
instruction. If the cleanuppad
is not inside a funclet,
this operand may be the token none
.
Arguments:¶
The instruction takes a list of arbitrary values which are interpreted by the personality function.
Semantics:¶
When the call stack is being unwound due to an exception being thrown,
the personality function transfers control to the
cleanuppad
with the aid of the personality-specific arguments.
As with calling conventions, how the personality function results are
represented in LLVM IR is target specific.
The cleanuppad
instruction has several restrictions:
- A cleanup block is a basic block which is the unwind destination of an exceptional instruction.
- A cleanup block must have a ‘
cleanuppad
‘ instruction as its first non-PHI instruction. - There can be only one ‘
cleanuppad
‘ instruction within the cleanup block. - A basic block that is not a cleanup block may not include a
‘
cleanuppad
‘ instruction.
When a cleanuppad
has been “entered” but not yet “exited” (as
described in the EH documentation),
it is undefined behavior to execute a call or invoke
that does not carry an appropriate “funclet” bundle.
Intrinsic Functions¶
LLVM supports the notion of an “intrinsic function”. These functions have well known names and semantics and are required to follow certain restrictions. Overall, these intrinsics represent an extension mechanism for the LLVM language that does not require changing all of the transformations in LLVM when adding to the language (or the bitcode reader/writer, the parser, etc...).
Intrinsic function names must all start with an “llvm.
” prefix. This
prefix is reserved in LLVM for intrinsic names; thus, function names may
not begin with this prefix. Intrinsic functions must always be external
functions: you cannot define the body of intrinsic functions. Intrinsic
functions may only be used in call or invoke instructions: it is illegal
to take the address of an intrinsic function. Additionally, because
intrinsic functions are part of the LLVM language, it is required if any
are added that they be documented here.
Some intrinsic functions can be overloaded, i.e., the intrinsic represents a family of functions that perform the same operation but on different data types. Because LLVM can represent over 8 million different integer types, overloading is used commonly to allow an intrinsic function to operate on any integer type. One or more of the argument types or the result type can be overloaded to accept any integer type. Argument types may also be defined as exactly matching a previous argument’s type or the result type. This allows an intrinsic function which accepts multiple arguments, but needs all of them to be of the same type, to only be overloaded with respect to a single argument or the result.
Overloaded intrinsics will have the names of its overloaded argument
types encoded into its function name, each preceded by a period. Only
those types which are overloaded result in a name suffix. Arguments
whose type is matched against another type do not. For example, the
llvm.ctpop
function can take an integer of any width and returns an
integer of exactly the same integer width. This leads to a family of
functions such as i8 @llvm.ctpop.i8(i8 %val)
and
i29 @llvm.ctpop.i29(i29 %val)
. Only one type, the return type, is
overloaded, and only one type suffix is required. Because the argument’s
type is matched against the return type, it does not require its own
name suffix.
To learn how to add an intrinsic function, please see the Extending LLVM Guide.
Variable Argument Handling Intrinsics¶
Variable argument support is defined in LLVM with the
va_arg instruction and these three intrinsic
functions. These functions are related to the similarly named macros
defined in the <stdarg.h>
header file.
All of these functions operate on arguments that use a target-specific
value type “va_list
”. The LLVM assembly language reference manual
does not define what this type is, so all transformations should be
prepared to handle these functions regardless of the type used.
This example shows how the va_arg instruction and the variable argument handling intrinsic functions are used.
; This struct is different for every platform. For most platforms,
; it is merely an i8*.
%struct.va_list = type { i8* }
; For Unix x86_64 platforms, va_list is the following struct:
; %struct.va_list = type { i32, i32, i8*, i8* }
define i32 @test(i32 %X, ...) {
; Initialize variable argument processing
%ap = alloca %struct.va_list
%ap2 = bitcast %struct.va_list* %ap to i8*
call void @llvm.va_start(i8* %ap2)
; Read a single integer argument
%tmp = va_arg i8* %ap2, i32
; Demonstrate usage of llvm.va_copy and llvm.va_end
%aq = alloca i8*
%aq2 = bitcast i8** %aq to i8*
call void @llvm.va_copy(i8* %aq2, i8* %ap2)
call void @llvm.va_end(i8* %aq2)
; Stop processing of arguments.
call void @llvm.va_end(i8* %ap2)
ret i32 %tmp
}
declare void @llvm.va_start(i8*)
declare void @llvm.va_copy(i8*, i8*)
declare void @llvm.va_end(i8*)
‘llvm.va_start
‘ Intrinsic¶
Arguments:¶
The argument is a pointer to a va_list
element to initialize.
Semantics:¶
The ‘llvm.va_start
‘ intrinsic works just like the va_start
macro
available in C. In a target-dependent way, it initializes the
va_list
element to which the argument points, so that the next call
to va_arg
will produce the first variable argument passed to the
function. Unlike the C va_start
macro, this intrinsic does not need
to know the last argument of the function as the compiler can figure
that out.
‘llvm.va_end
‘ Intrinsic¶
Overview:¶
The ‘llvm.va_end
‘ intrinsic destroys *<arglist>
, which has been
initialized previously with llvm.va_start
or llvm.va_copy
.
Arguments:¶
The argument is a pointer to a va_list
to destroy.
Semantics:¶
The ‘llvm.va_end
‘ intrinsic works just like the va_end
macro
available in C. In a target-dependent way, it destroys the va_list
element to which the argument points. Calls to
llvm.va_start and
llvm.va_copy must be matched exactly with calls to
llvm.va_end
.
‘llvm.va_copy
‘ Intrinsic¶
Overview:¶
The ‘llvm.va_copy
‘ intrinsic copies the current argument position
from the source argument list to the destination argument list.
Arguments:¶
The first argument is a pointer to a va_list
element to initialize.
The second argument is a pointer to a va_list
element to copy from.
Semantics:¶
The ‘llvm.va_copy
‘ intrinsic works just like the va_copy
macro
available in C. In a target-dependent way, it copies the source
va_list
element into the destination va_list
element. This
intrinsic is necessary because the `` llvm.va_start`` intrinsic may be
arbitrarily complex and require, for example, memory allocation.
Accurate Garbage Collection Intrinsics¶
LLVM’s support for Accurate Garbage Collection (GC) requires the frontend to generate code containing appropriate intrinsic calls and select an appropriate GC strategy which knows how to lower these intrinsics in a manner which is appropriate for the target collector.
These intrinsics allow identification of GC roots on the stack, as well as garbage collector implementations that require read and write barriers. Frontends for type-safe garbage collected languages should generate these intrinsics to make use of the LLVM garbage collectors. For more details, see Garbage Collection with LLVM.
Experimental Statepoint Intrinsics¶
LLVM provides an second experimental set of intrinsics for describing garbage
collection safepoints in compiled code. These intrinsics are an alternative
to the llvm.gcroot
intrinsics, but are compatible with the ones for
read and write barriers. The
differences in approach are covered in the Garbage Collection with LLVM documentation. The intrinsics themselves are
described in Garbage Collection Safepoints in LLVM.
‘llvm.gcroot
‘ Intrinsic¶
Overview:¶
The ‘llvm.gcroot
‘ intrinsic declares the existence of a GC root to
the code generator, and allows some metadata to be associated with it.
Arguments:¶
The first argument specifies the address of a stack object that contains the root pointer. The second pointer (which must be either a constant or a global value address) contains the meta-data to be associated with the root.
Semantics:¶
At runtime, a call to this intrinsic stores a null pointer into the
“ptrloc” location. At compile-time, the code generator generates
information to allow the runtime to find the pointer at GC safe points.
The ‘llvm.gcroot
‘ intrinsic may only be used in a function which
specifies a GC algorithm.
‘llvm.gcread
‘ Intrinsic¶
Overview:¶
The ‘llvm.gcread
‘ intrinsic identifies reads of references from heap
locations, allowing garbage collector implementations that require read
barriers.
Arguments:¶
The second argument is the address to read from, which should be an address allocated from the garbage collector. The first object is a pointer to the start of the referenced object, if needed by the language runtime (otherwise null).
Semantics:¶
The ‘llvm.gcread
‘ intrinsic has the same semantics as a load
instruction, but may be replaced with substantially more complex code by
the garbage collector runtime, as needed. The ‘llvm.gcread
‘
intrinsic may only be used in a function which specifies a GC
algorithm.
‘llvm.gcwrite
‘ Intrinsic¶
Overview:¶
The ‘llvm.gcwrite
‘ intrinsic identifies writes of references to heap
locations, allowing garbage collector implementations that require write
barriers (such as generational or reference counting collectors).
Arguments:¶
The first argument is the reference to store, the second is the start of the object to store it to, and the third is the address of the field of Obj to store to. If the runtime does not require a pointer to the object, Obj may be null.
Semantics:¶
The ‘llvm.gcwrite
‘ intrinsic has the same semantics as a store
instruction, but may be replaced with substantially more complex code by
the garbage collector runtime, as needed. The ‘llvm.gcwrite
‘
intrinsic may only be used in a function which specifies a GC
algorithm.
Code Generator Intrinsics¶
These intrinsics are provided by LLVM to expose special features that may only be implemented with code generator support.
‘llvm.returnaddress
‘ Intrinsic¶
Overview:¶
The ‘llvm.returnaddress
‘ intrinsic attempts to compute a
target-specific value indicating the return address of the current
function or one of its callers.
Arguments:¶
The argument to this intrinsic indicates which function to return the address for. Zero indicates the calling function, one indicates its caller, etc. The argument is required to be a constant integer value.
Semantics:¶
The ‘llvm.returnaddress
‘ intrinsic either returns a pointer
indicating the return address of the specified call frame, or zero if it
cannot be identified. The value returned by this intrinsic is likely to
be incorrect or 0 for arguments other than zero, so it should only be
used for debugging purposes.
Note that calling this intrinsic does not prevent function inlining or other aggressive transformations, so the value returned may not be that of the obvious source-language caller.
‘llvm.frameaddress
‘ Intrinsic¶
Overview:¶
The ‘llvm.frameaddress
‘ intrinsic attempts to return the
target-specific frame pointer value for the specified stack frame.
Arguments:¶
The argument to this intrinsic indicates which function to return the frame pointer for. Zero indicates the calling function, one indicates its caller, etc. The argument is required to be a constant integer value.
Semantics:¶
The ‘llvm.frameaddress
‘ intrinsic either returns a pointer
indicating the frame address of the specified call frame, or zero if it
cannot be identified. The value returned by this intrinsic is likely to
be incorrect or 0 for arguments other than zero, so it should only be
used for debugging purposes.
Note that calling this intrinsic does not prevent function inlining or other aggressive transformations, so the value returned may not be that of the obvious source-language caller.
‘llvm.localescape
‘ and ‘llvm.localrecover
‘ Intrinsics¶
Syntax:¶
declare void @llvm.localescape(...)
declare i8* @llvm.localrecover(i8* %func, i8* %fp, i32 %idx)
Overview:¶
The ‘llvm.localescape
‘ intrinsic escapes offsets of a collection of static
allocas, and the ‘llvm.localrecover
‘ intrinsic applies those offsets to a
live frame pointer to recover the address of the allocation. The offset is
computed during frame layout of the caller of llvm.localescape
.
Arguments:¶
All arguments to ‘llvm.localescape
‘ must be pointers to static allocas or
casts of static allocas. Each function can only call ‘llvm.localescape
‘
once, and it can only do so from the entry block.
The func
argument to ‘llvm.localrecover
‘ must be a constant
bitcasted pointer to a function defined in the current module. The code
generator cannot determine the frame allocation offset of functions defined in
other modules.
The fp
argument to ‘llvm.localrecover
‘ must be a frame pointer of a
call frame that is currently live. The return value of ‘llvm.localaddress
‘
is one way to produce such a value, but various runtimes also expose a suitable
pointer in platform-specific ways.
The idx
argument to ‘llvm.localrecover
‘ indicates which alloca passed to
‘llvm.localescape
‘ to recover. It is zero-indexed.
Semantics:¶
These intrinsics allow a group of functions to share access to a set of local
stack allocations of a one parent function. The parent function may call the
‘llvm.localescape
‘ intrinsic once from the function entry block, and the
child functions can use ‘llvm.localrecover
‘ to access the escaped allocas.
The ‘llvm.localescape
‘ intrinsic blocks inlining, as inlining changes where
the escaped allocas are allocated, which would break attempts to use
‘llvm.localrecover
‘.
‘llvm.read_register
‘ and ‘llvm.write_register
‘ Intrinsics¶
Syntax:¶
declare i32 @llvm.read_register.i32(metadata)
declare i64 @llvm.read_register.i64(metadata)
declare void @llvm.write_register.i32(metadata, i32 @value)
declare void @llvm.write_register.i64(metadata, i64 @value)
!0 = !{!"sp\00"}
Overview:¶
The ‘llvm.read_register
‘ and ‘llvm.write_register
‘ intrinsics
provides access to the named register. The register must be valid on
the architecture being compiled to. The type needs to be compatible
with the register being read.
Semantics:¶
The ‘llvm.read_register
‘ intrinsic returns the current value of the
register, where possible. The ‘llvm.write_register
‘ intrinsic sets
the current value of the register, where possible.
This is useful to implement named register global variables that need to always be mapped to a specific register, as is common practice on bare-metal programs including OS kernels.
The compiler doesn’t check for register availability or use of the used register in surrounding code, including inline assembly. Because of that, allocatable registers are not supported.
Warning: So far it only works with the stack pointer on selected architectures (ARM, AArch64, PowerPC and x86_64). Significant amount of work is needed to support other registers and even more so, allocatable registers.
‘llvm.stacksave
‘ Intrinsic¶
Overview:¶
The ‘llvm.stacksave
‘ intrinsic is used to remember the current state
of the function stack, for use with
llvm.stackrestore. This is useful for
implementing language features like scoped automatic variable sized
arrays in C99.
Semantics:¶
This intrinsic returns a opaque pointer value that can be passed to
llvm.stackrestore. When an
llvm.stackrestore
intrinsic is executed with a value saved from
llvm.stacksave
, it effectively restores the state of the stack to
the state it was in when the llvm.stacksave
intrinsic executed. In
practice, this pops any alloca blocks from the stack that
were allocated after the llvm.stacksave
was executed.
‘llvm.stackrestore
‘ Intrinsic¶
Overview:¶
The ‘llvm.stackrestore
‘ intrinsic is used to restore the state of
the function stack to the state it was in when the corresponding
llvm.stacksave intrinsic executed. This is
useful for implementing language features like scoped automatic variable
sized arrays in C99.
Semantics:¶
See the description for llvm.stacksave.
‘llvm.get.dynamic.area.offset
‘ Intrinsic¶
Syntax:¶
declare i32 @llvm.get.dynamic.area.offset.i32()
declare i64 @llvm.get.dynamic.area.offset.i64()
Overview:
"""""""""
The '``llvm.get.dynamic.area.offset.*``' intrinsic family is used to
get the offset from native stack pointer to the address of the most
recent dynamic alloca on the caller's stack. These intrinsics are
intendend for use in combination with
:ref:`llvm.stacksave <int_stacksave>` to get a
pointer to the most recent dynamic alloca. This is useful, for example,
for AddressSanitizer's stack unpoisoning routines.
Semantics:¶
These intrinsics return a non-negative integer value that can be used to get the address of the most recent dynamic alloca, allocated by alloca on the caller’s stack. In particular, for targets where stack grows downwards, adding this offset to the native stack pointer would get the address of the most recent dynamic alloca. For targets where stack grows upwards, the situation is a bit more complicated, because substracting this value from stack pointer would get the address one past the end of the most recent dynamic alloca.
Although for most targets llvm.get.dynamic.area.offset <int_get_dynamic_area_offset> returns just a zero, for others, such as PowerPC and PowerPC64, it returns a compile-time-known constant value.
The return value type of llvm.get.dynamic.area.offset must match the target’s generic address space’s (address space 0) pointer type.
‘llvm.prefetch
‘ Intrinsic¶
Overview:¶
The ‘llvm.prefetch
‘ intrinsic is a hint to the code generator to
insert a prefetch instruction if supported; otherwise, it is a noop.
Prefetches have no effect on the behavior of the program but can change
its performance characteristics.
Arguments:¶
address
is the address to be prefetched, rw
is the specifier
determining if the fetch should be for a read (0) or write (1), and
locality
is a temporal locality specifier ranging from (0) - no
locality, to (3) - extremely local keep in cache. The cache type
specifies whether the prefetch is performed on the data (1) or
instruction (0) cache. The rw
, locality
and cache type
arguments must be constant integers.
Semantics:¶
This intrinsic does not modify the behavior of the program. In particular, prefetches cannot trap and do not produce a value. On targets that support this intrinsic, the prefetch can provide hints to the processor cache for better performance.
‘llvm.pcmarker
‘ Intrinsic¶
Overview:¶
The ‘llvm.pcmarker
‘ intrinsic is a method to export a Program
Counter (PC) in a region of code to simulators and other tools. The
method is target specific, but it is expected that the marker will use
exported symbols to transmit the PC of the marker. The marker makes no
guarantees that it will remain with any specific instruction after
optimizations. It is possible that the presence of a marker will inhibit
optimizations. The intended use is to be inserted after optimizations to
allow correlations of simulation runs.
Arguments:¶
id
is a numerical id identifying the marker.
Semantics:¶
This intrinsic does not modify the behavior of the program. Backends that do not support this intrinsic may ignore it.
‘llvm.readcyclecounter
‘ Intrinsic¶
Overview:¶
The ‘llvm.readcyclecounter
‘ intrinsic provides access to the cycle
counter register (or similar low latency, high accuracy clocks) on those
targets that support it. On X86, it should map to RDTSC. On Alpha, it
should map to RPCC. As the backing counters overflow quickly (on the
order of 9 seconds on alpha), this should only be used for small
timings.
Semantics:¶
When directly supported, reading the cycle counter should not modify any memory. Implementations are allowed to either return a application specific value or a system wide value. On backends without support, this is lowered to a constant 0.
Note that runtime support may be conditional on the privilege-level code is running at and the host platform.
‘llvm.clear_cache
‘ Intrinsic¶
Overview:¶
The ‘llvm.clear_cache
‘ intrinsic ensures visibility of modifications
in the specified range to the execution unit of the processor. On
targets with non-unified instruction and data cache, the implementation
flushes the instruction cache.
Semantics:¶
On platforms with coherent instruction and data caches (e.g. x86), this intrinsic is a nop. On platforms with non-coherent instruction and data cache (e.g. ARM, MIPS), the intrinsic is lowered either to appropriate instructions or a system call, if cache flushing requires special privileges.
The default behavior is to emit a call to __clear_cache
from the run
time library.
This instrinsic does not empty the instruction pipeline. Modifications of the current function are outside the scope of the intrinsic.
‘llvm.instrprof_increment
‘ Intrinsic¶
Syntax:¶
declare void @llvm.instrprof_increment(i8* <name>, i64 <hash>,
i32 <num-counters>, i32 <index>)
Overview:¶
The ‘llvm.instrprof_increment
‘ intrinsic can be emitted by a
frontend for use with instrumentation based profiling. These will be
lowered by the -instrprof
pass to generate execution counts of a
program at runtime.
Arguments:¶
The first argument is a pointer to a global variable containing the name of the entity being instrumented. This should generally be the (mangled) function name for a set of counters.
The second argument is a hash value that can be used by the consumer
of the profile data to detect changes to the instrumented source, and
the third is the number of counters associated with name
. It is an
error if hash
or num-counters
differ between two instances of
instrprof_increment
that refer to the same name.
The last argument refers to which of the counters for name
should
be incremented. It should be a value between 0 and num-counters
.
Semantics:¶
This intrinsic represents an increment of a profiling counter. It will
cause the -instrprof
pass to generate the appropriate data
structures and the code to increment the appropriate value, in a
format that can be written out by a compiler runtime and consumed via
the llvm-profdata
tool.
‘llvm.instrprof_value_profile
‘ Intrinsic¶
Syntax:¶
declare void @llvm.instrprof_value_profile(i8* <name>, i64 <hash>,
i64 <value>, i32 <value_kind>,
i32 <index>)
Overview:¶
The ‘llvm.instrprof_value_profile
‘ intrinsic can be emitted by a
frontend for use with instrumentation based profiling. This will be
lowered by the -instrprof
pass to find out the target values,
instrumented expressions take in a program at runtime.
Arguments:¶
The first argument is a pointer to a global variable containing the
name of the entity being instrumented. name
should generally be the
(mangled) function name for a set of counters.
The second argument is a hash value that can be used by the consumer
of the profile data to detect changes to the instrumented source. It
is an error if hash
differs between two instances of
llvm.instrprof_*
that refer to the same name.
The third argument is the value of the expression being profiled. The profiled
expression’s value should be representable as an unsigned 64-bit value. The
fourth argument represents the kind of value profiling that is being done. The
supported value profiling kinds are enumerated through the
InstrProfValueKind
type declared in the
<include/llvm/ProfileData/InstrProf.h>
header file. The last argument is the
index of the instrumented expression within name
. It should be >= 0.
Semantics:¶
This intrinsic represents the point where a call to a runtime routine
should be inserted for value profiling of target expressions. -instrprof
pass will generate the appropriate data structures and replace the
llvm.instrprof_value_profile
intrinsic with the call to the profile
runtime library with proper arguments.
Standard C Library Intrinsics¶
LLVM provides intrinsics for a few important standard C library functions. These intrinsics allow source-language front-ends to pass information about the alignment of the pointer arguments to the code generator, providing opportunity for more efficient code generation.
‘llvm.memcpy
‘ Intrinsic¶
Syntax:¶
This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use llvm.memcpy
on any
integer bit width and for different address spaces. Not all targets
support all bit widths however.
declare void @llvm.memcpy.p0i8.p0i8.i32(i8* <dest>, i8* <src>,
i32 <len>, i32 <align>, i1 <isvolatile>)
declare void @llvm.memcpy.p0i8.p0i8.i64(i8* <dest>, i8* <src>,
i64 <len>, i32 <align>, i1 <isvolatile>)
Overview:¶
The ‘llvm.memcpy.*
‘ intrinsics copy a block of memory from the
source location to the destination location.
Note that, unlike the standard libc function, the llvm.memcpy.*
intrinsics do not return a value, takes extra alignment/isvolatile
arguments and the pointers can be in specified address spaces.
Arguments:¶
The first argument is a pointer to the destination, the second is a pointer to the source. The third argument is an integer argument specifying the number of bytes to copy, the fourth argument is the alignment of the source and destination locations, and the fifth is a boolean indicating a volatile access.
If the call to this intrinsic has an alignment value that is not 0 or 1, then the caller guarantees that both the source and destination pointers are aligned to that boundary.
If the isvolatile
parameter is true
, the llvm.memcpy
call is
a volatile operation. The detailed access behavior is not
very cleanly specified and it is unwise to depend on it.
Semantics:¶
The ‘llvm.memcpy.*
‘ intrinsics copy a block of memory from the
source location to the destination location, which are not allowed to
overlap. It copies “len” bytes of memory over. If the argument is known
to be aligned to some boundary, this can be specified as the fourth
argument, otherwise it should be set to 0 or 1 (both meaning no alignment).
‘llvm.memmove
‘ Intrinsic¶
Syntax:¶
This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use llvm.memmove on any integer bit width and for different address space. Not all targets support all bit widths however.
declare void @llvm.memmove.p0i8.p0i8.i32(i8* <dest>, i8* <src>,
i32 <len>, i32 <align>, i1 <isvolatile>)
declare void @llvm.memmove.p0i8.p0i8.i64(i8* <dest>, i8* <src>,
i64 <len>, i32 <align>, i1 <isvolatile>)
Overview:¶
The ‘llvm.memmove.*
‘ intrinsics move a block of memory from the
source location to the destination location. It is similar to the
‘llvm.memcpy
‘ intrinsic but allows the two memory locations to
overlap.
Note that, unlike the standard libc function, the llvm.memmove.*
intrinsics do not return a value, takes extra alignment/isvolatile
arguments and the pointers can be in specified address spaces.
Arguments:¶
The first argument is a pointer to the destination, the second is a pointer to the source. The third argument is an integer argument specifying the number of bytes to copy, the fourth argument is the alignment of the source and destination locations, and the fifth is a boolean indicating a volatile access.
If the call to this intrinsic has an alignment value that is not 0 or 1, then the caller guarantees that the source and destination pointers are aligned to that boundary.
If the isvolatile
parameter is true
, the llvm.memmove
call
is a volatile operation. The detailed access behavior is
not very cleanly specified and it is unwise to depend on it.
Semantics:¶
The ‘llvm.memmove.*
‘ intrinsics copy a block of memory from the
source location to the destination location, which may overlap. It
copies “len” bytes of memory over. If the argument is known to be
aligned to some boundary, this can be specified as the fourth argument,
otherwise it should be set to 0 or 1 (both meaning no alignment).
‘llvm.memset.*
‘ Intrinsics¶
Syntax:¶
This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use llvm.memset on any integer bit width and for different address spaces. However, not all targets support all bit widths.
declare void @llvm.memset.p0i8.i32(i8* <dest>, i8 <val>,
i32 <len>, i32 <align>, i1 <isvolatile>)
declare void @llvm.memset.p0i8.i64(i8* <dest>, i8 <val>,
i64 <len>, i32 <align>, i1 <isvolatile>)
Overview:¶
The ‘llvm.memset.*
‘ intrinsics fill a block of memory with a
particular byte value.
Note that, unlike the standard libc function, the llvm.memset
intrinsic does not return a value and takes extra alignment/volatile
arguments. Also, the destination can be in an arbitrary address space.
Arguments:¶
The first argument is a pointer to the destination to fill, the second is the byte value with which to fill it, the third argument is an integer argument specifying the number of bytes to fill, and the fourth argument is the known alignment of the destination location.
If the call to this intrinsic has an alignment value that is not 0 or 1, then the caller guarantees that the destination pointer is aligned to that boundary.
If the isvolatile
parameter is true
, the llvm.memset
call is
a volatile operation. The detailed access behavior is not
very cleanly specified and it is unwise to depend on it.
Semantics:¶
The ‘llvm.memset.*
‘ intrinsics fill “len” bytes of memory starting
at the destination location. If the argument is known to be aligned to
some boundary, this can be specified as the fourth argument, otherwise
it should be set to 0 or 1 (both meaning no alignment).
‘llvm.sqrt.*
‘ Intrinsic¶
Syntax:¶
This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use llvm.sqrt
on any
floating point or vector of floating point type. Not all targets support
all types however.
declare float @llvm.sqrt.f32(float %Val)
declare double @llvm.sqrt.f64(double %Val)
declare x86_fp80 @llvm.sqrt.f80(x86_fp80 %Val)
declare fp128 @llvm.sqrt.f128(fp128 %Val)
declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.sqrt.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val)
Overview:¶
The ‘llvm.sqrt
‘ intrinsics return the sqrt of the specified operand,
returning the same value as the libm ‘sqrt
‘ functions would. Unlike
sqrt
in libm, however, llvm.sqrt
has undefined behavior for
negative numbers other than -0.0 (which allows for better optimization,
because there is no need to worry about errno being set).
llvm.sqrt(-0.0)
is defined to return -0.0 like IEEE sqrt.
Arguments:¶
The argument and return value are floating point numbers of the same type.
Semantics:¶
This function returns the sqrt of the specified operand if it is a nonnegative floating point number.
‘llvm.powi.*
‘ Intrinsic¶
Syntax:¶
This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use llvm.powi
on any
floating point or vector of floating point type. Not all targets support
all types however.
declare float @llvm.powi.f32(float %Val, i32 %power)
declare double @llvm.powi.f64(double %Val, i32 %power)
declare x86_fp80 @llvm.powi.f80(x86_fp80 %Val, i32 %power)
declare fp128 @llvm.powi.f128(fp128 %Val, i32 %power)
declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.powi.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val, i32 %power)
Overview:¶
The ‘llvm.powi.*
‘ intrinsics return the first operand raised to the
specified (positive or negative) power. The order of evaluation of
multiplications is not defined. When a vector of floating point type is
used, the second argument remains a scalar integer value.
Arguments:¶
The second argument is an integer power, and the first is a value to raise to that power.
Semantics:¶
This function returns the first value raised to the second power with an unspecified sequence of rounding operations.
‘llvm.sin.*
‘ Intrinsic¶
Syntax:¶
This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use llvm.sin
on any
floating point or vector of floating point type. Not all targets support
all types however.
declare float @llvm.sin.f32(float %Val)
declare double @llvm.sin.f64(double %Val)
declare x86_fp80 @llvm.sin.f80(x86_fp80 %Val)
declare fp128 @llvm.sin.f128(fp128 %Val)
declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.sin.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val)
Arguments:¶
The argument and return value are floating point numbers of the same type.
Semantics:¶
This function returns the sine of the specified operand, returning the
same values as the libm sin
functions would, and handles error
conditions in the same way.
‘llvm.cos.*
‘ Intrinsic¶
Syntax:¶
This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use llvm.cos
on any
floating point or vector of floating point type. Not all targets support
all types however.
declare float @llvm.cos.f32(float %Val)
declare double @llvm.cos.f64(double %Val)
declare x86_fp80 @llvm.cos.f80(x86_fp80 %Val)
declare fp128 @llvm.cos.f128(fp128 %Val)
declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.cos.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val)
Arguments:¶
The argument and return value are floating point numbers of the same type.
Semantics:¶
This function returns the cosine of the specified operand, returning the
same values as the libm cos
functions would, and handles error
conditions in the same way.
‘llvm.pow.*
‘ Intrinsic¶
Syntax:¶
This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use llvm.pow
on any
floating point or vector of floating point type. Not all targets support
all types however.
declare float @llvm.pow.f32(float %Val, float %Power)
declare double @llvm.pow.f64(double %Val, double %Power)
declare x86_fp80 @llvm.pow.f80(x86_fp80 %Val, x86_fp80 %Power)
declare fp128 @llvm.pow.f128(fp128 %Val, fp128 %Power)
declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.pow.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val, ppc_fp128 Power)
Overview:¶
The ‘llvm.pow.*
‘ intrinsics return the first operand raised to the
specified (positive or negative) power.
Arguments:¶
The second argument is a floating point power, and the first is a value to raise to that power.
Semantics:¶
This function returns the first value raised to the second power,
returning the same values as the libm pow
functions would, and
handles error conditions in the same way.
‘llvm.exp.*
‘ Intrinsic¶
Syntax:¶
This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use llvm.exp
on any
floating point or vector of floating point type. Not all targets support
all types however.
declare float @llvm.exp.f32(float %Val)
declare double @llvm.exp.f64(double %Val)
declare x86_fp80 @llvm.exp.f80(x86_fp80 %Val)
declare fp128 @llvm.exp.f128(fp128 %Val)
declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.exp.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val)
Arguments:¶
The argument and return value are floating point numbers of the same type.
Semantics:¶
This function returns the same values as the libm exp
functions
would, and handles error conditions in the same way.
‘llvm.exp2.*
‘ Intrinsic¶
Syntax:¶
This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use llvm.exp2
on any
floating point or vector of floating point type. Not all targets support
all types however.
declare float @llvm.exp2.f32(float %Val)
declare double @llvm.exp2.f64(double %Val)
declare x86_fp80 @llvm.exp2.f80(x86_fp80 %Val)
declare fp128 @llvm.exp2.f128(fp128 %Val)
declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.exp2.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val)
Arguments:¶
The argument and return value are floating point numbers of the same type.
Semantics:¶
This function returns the same values as the libm exp2
functions
would, and handles error conditions in the same way.
‘llvm.log.*
‘ Intrinsic¶
Syntax:¶
This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use llvm.log
on any
floating point or vector of floating point type. Not all targets support
all types however.
declare float @llvm.log.f32(float %Val)
declare double @llvm.log.f64(double %Val)
declare x86_fp80 @llvm.log.f80(x86_fp80 %Val)
declare fp128 @llvm.log.f128(fp128 %Val)
declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.log.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val)
Arguments:¶
The argument and return value are floating point numbers of the same type.
Semantics:¶
This function returns the same values as the libm log
functions
would, and handles error conditions in the same way.
‘llvm.log10.*
‘ Intrinsic¶
Syntax:¶
This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use llvm.log10
on any
floating point or vector of floating point type. Not all targets support
all types however.
declare float @llvm.log10.f32(float %Val)
declare double @llvm.log10.f64(double %Val)
declare x86_fp80 @llvm.log10.f80(x86_fp80 %Val)
declare fp128 @llvm.log10.f128(fp128 %Val)
declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.log10.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val)
Arguments:¶
The argument and return value are floating point numbers of the same type.
Semantics:¶
This function returns the same values as the libm log10
functions
would, and handles error conditions in the same way.
‘llvm.log2.*
‘ Intrinsic¶
Syntax:¶
This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use llvm.log2
on any
floating point or vector of floating point type. Not all targets support
all types however.
declare float @llvm.log2.f32(float %Val)
declare double @llvm.log2.f64(double %Val)
declare x86_fp80 @llvm.log2.f80(x86_fp80 %Val)
declare fp128 @llvm.log2.f128(fp128 %Val)
declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.log2.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val)
Arguments:¶
The argument and return value are floating point numbers of the same type.
Semantics:¶
This function returns the same values as the libm log2
functions
would, and handles error conditions in the same way.
‘llvm.fma.*
‘ Intrinsic¶
Syntax:¶
This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use llvm.fma
on any
floating point or vector of floating point type. Not all targets support
all types however.
declare float @llvm.fma.f32(float %a, float %b, float %c)
declare double @llvm.fma.f64(double %a, double %b, double %c)
declare x86_fp80 @llvm.fma.f80(x86_fp80 %a, x86_fp80 %b, x86_fp80 %c)
declare fp128 @llvm.fma.f128(fp128 %a, fp128 %b, fp128 %c)
declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.fma.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %a, ppc_fp128 %b, ppc_fp128 %c)
Arguments:¶
The argument and return value are floating point numbers of the same type.
Semantics:¶
This function returns the same values as the libm fma
functions
would, and does not set errno.
‘llvm.fabs.*
‘ Intrinsic¶
Syntax:¶
This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use llvm.fabs
on any
floating point or vector of floating point type. Not all targets support
all types however.
declare float @llvm.fabs.f32(float %Val)
declare double @llvm.fabs.f64(double %Val)
declare x86_fp80 @llvm.fabs.f80(x86_fp80 %Val)
declare fp128 @llvm.fabs.f128(fp128 %Val)
declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.fabs.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val)
Arguments:¶
The argument and return value are floating point numbers of the same type.
Semantics:¶
This function returns the same values as the libm fabs
functions
would, and handles error conditions in the same way.
‘llvm.minnum.*
‘ Intrinsic¶
Syntax:¶
This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use llvm.minnum
on any
floating point or vector of floating point type. Not all targets support
all types however.
declare float @llvm.minnum.f32(float %Val0, float %Val1)
declare double @llvm.minnum.f64(double %Val0, double %Val1)
declare x86_fp80 @llvm.minnum.f80(x86_fp80 %Val0, x86_fp80 %Val1)
declare fp128 @llvm.minnum.f128(fp128 %Val0, fp128 %Val1)
declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.minnum.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val0, ppc_fp128 %Val1)
Arguments:¶
The arguments and return value are floating point numbers of the same type.
Semantics:¶
Follows the IEEE-754 semantics for minNum, which also match for libm’s fmin.
If either operand is a NaN, returns the other non-NaN operand. Returns NaN only if both operands are NaN. If the operands compare equal, returns a value that compares equal to both operands. This means that fmin(+/-0.0, +/-0.0) could return either -0.0 or 0.0.
‘llvm.maxnum.*
‘ Intrinsic¶
Syntax:¶
This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use llvm.maxnum
on any
floating point or vector of floating point type. Not all targets support
all types however.
declare float @llvm.maxnum.f32(float %Val0, float %Val1l)
declare double @llvm.maxnum.f64(double %Val0, double %Val1)
declare x86_fp80 @llvm.maxnum.f80(x86_fp80 %Val0, x86_fp80 %Val1)
declare fp128 @llvm.maxnum.f128(fp128 %Val0, fp128 %Val1)
declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.maxnum.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val0, ppc_fp128 %Val1)
Arguments:¶
The arguments and return value are floating point numbers of the same type.
Semantics:¶
Follows the IEEE-754 semantics for maxNum, which also match for libm’s fmax.
If either operand is a NaN, returns the other non-NaN operand. Returns NaN only if both operands are NaN. If the operands compare equal, returns a value that compares equal to both operands. This means that fmax(+/-0.0, +/-0.0) could return either -0.0 or 0.0.
‘llvm.copysign.*
‘ Intrinsic¶
Syntax:¶
This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use llvm.copysign
on any
floating point or vector of floating point type. Not all targets support
all types however.
declare float @llvm.copysign.f32(float %Mag, float %Sgn)
declare double @llvm.copysign.f64(double %Mag, double %Sgn)
declare x86_fp80 @llvm.copysign.f80(x86_fp80 %Mag, x86_fp80 %Sgn)
declare fp128 @llvm.copysign.f128(fp128 %Mag, fp128 %Sgn)
declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.copysign.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Mag, ppc_fp128 %Sgn)
Overview:¶
The ‘llvm.copysign.*
‘ intrinsics return a value with the magnitude of the
first operand and the sign of the second operand.
Arguments:¶
The arguments and return value are floating point numbers of the same type.
Semantics:¶
This function returns the same values as the libm copysign
functions would, and handles error conditions in the same way.
‘llvm.floor.*
‘ Intrinsic¶
Syntax:¶
This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use llvm.floor
on any
floating point or vector of floating point type. Not all targets support
all types however.
declare float @llvm.floor.f32(float %Val)
declare double @llvm.floor.f64(double %Val)
declare x86_fp80 @llvm.floor.f80(x86_fp80 %Val)
declare fp128 @llvm.floor.f128(fp128 %Val)
declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.floor.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val)
Arguments:¶
The argument and return value are floating point numbers of the same type.
Semantics:¶
This function returns the same values as the libm floor
functions
would, and handles error conditions in the same way.
‘llvm.ceil.*
‘ Intrinsic¶
Syntax:¶
This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use llvm.ceil
on any
floating point or vector of floating point type. Not all targets support
all types however.
declare float @llvm.ceil.f32(float %Val)
declare double @llvm.ceil.f64(double %Val)
declare x86_fp80 @llvm.ceil.f80(x86_fp80 %Val)
declare fp128 @llvm.ceil.f128(fp128 %Val)
declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.ceil.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val)
Arguments:¶
The argument and return value are floating point numbers of the same type.
Semantics:¶
This function returns the same values as the libm ceil
functions
would, and handles error conditions in the same way.
‘llvm.trunc.*
‘ Intrinsic¶
Syntax:¶
This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use llvm.trunc
on any
floating point or vector of floating point type. Not all targets support
all types however.
declare float @llvm.trunc.f32(float %Val)
declare double @llvm.trunc.f64(double %Val)
declare x86_fp80 @llvm.trunc.f80(x86_fp80 %Val)
declare fp128 @llvm.trunc.f128(fp128 %Val)
declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.trunc.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val)
Overview:¶
The ‘llvm.trunc.*
‘ intrinsics returns the operand rounded to the
nearest integer not larger in magnitude than the operand.
Arguments:¶
The argument and return value are floating point numbers of the same type.
Semantics:¶
This function returns the same values as the libm trunc
functions
would, and handles error conditions in the same way.
‘llvm.rint.*
‘ Intrinsic¶
Syntax:¶
This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use llvm.rint
on any
floating point or vector of floating point type. Not all targets support
all types however.
declare float @llvm.rint.f32(float %Val)
declare double @llvm.rint.f64(double %Val)
declare x86_fp80 @llvm.rint.f80(x86_fp80 %Val)
declare fp128 @llvm.rint.f128(fp128 %Val)
declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.rint.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val)
Overview:¶
The ‘llvm.rint.*
‘ intrinsics returns the operand rounded to the
nearest integer. It may raise an inexact floating-point exception if the
operand isn’t an integer.
Arguments:¶
The argument and return value are floating point numbers of the same type.
Semantics:¶
This function returns the same values as the libm rint
functions
would, and handles error conditions in the same way.
‘llvm.nearbyint.*
‘ Intrinsic¶
Syntax:¶
This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use llvm.nearbyint
on any
floating point or vector of floating point type. Not all targets support
all types however.
declare float @llvm.nearbyint.f32(float %Val)
declare double @llvm.nearbyint.f64(double %Val)
declare x86_fp80 @llvm.nearbyint.f80(x86_fp80 %Val)
declare fp128 @llvm.nearbyint.f128(fp128 %Val)
declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.nearbyint.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val)
Arguments:¶
The argument and return value are floating point numbers of the same type.
Semantics:¶
This function returns the same values as the libm nearbyint
functions would, and handles error conditions in the same way.
‘llvm.round.*
‘ Intrinsic¶
Syntax:¶
This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use llvm.round
on any
floating point or vector of floating point type. Not all targets support
all types however.
declare float @llvm.round.f32(float %Val)
declare double @llvm.round.f64(double %Val)
declare x86_fp80 @llvm.round.f80(x86_fp80 %Val)
declare fp128 @llvm.round.f128(fp128 %Val)
declare ppc_fp128 @llvm.round.ppcf128(ppc_fp128 %Val)
Arguments:¶
The argument and return value are floating point numbers of the same type.
Semantics:¶
This function returns the same values as the libm round
functions would, and handles error conditions in the same way.
Bit Manipulation Intrinsics¶
LLVM provides intrinsics for a few important bit manipulation operations. These allow efficient code generation for some algorithms.
‘llvm.bitreverse.*
‘ Intrinsics¶
Syntax:¶
This is an overloaded intrinsic function. You can use bitreverse on any integer type.
declare i16 @llvm.bitreverse.i16(i16 <id>)
declare i32 @llvm.bitreverse.i32(i32 <id>)
declare i64 @llvm.bitreverse.i64(i64 <id>)
Overview:¶
The ‘llvm.bitreverse
‘ family of intrinsics is used to reverse the
bitpattern of an integer value; for example 0b10110110
becomes
0b01101101
.
Semantics:¶
The llvm.bitreverse.iN
intrinsic returns an i16 value that has bit
M
in the input moved to bit N-M
in the output.
‘llvm.bswap.*
‘ Intrinsics¶
Syntax:¶
This is an overloaded intrinsic function. You can use bswap on any integer type that is an even number of bytes (i.e. BitWidth % 16 == 0).
declare i16 @llvm.bswap.i16(i16 <id>)
declare i32 @llvm.bswap.i32(i32 <id>)
declare i64 @llvm.bswap.i64(i64 <id>)
Overview:¶
The ‘llvm.bswap
‘ family of intrinsics is used to byte swap integer
values with an even number of bytes (positive multiple of 16 bits).
These are useful for performing operations on data that is not in the
target’s native byte order.
Semantics:¶
The llvm.bswap.i16
intrinsic returns an i16 value that has the high
and low byte of the input i16 swapped. Similarly, the llvm.bswap.i32
intrinsic returns an i32 value that has the four bytes of the input i32
swapped, so that if the input bytes are numbered 0, 1, 2, 3 then the
returned i32 will have its bytes in 3, 2, 1, 0 order. The
llvm.bswap.i48
, llvm.bswap.i64
and other intrinsics extend this
concept to additional even-byte lengths (6 bytes, 8 bytes and more,
respectively).
‘llvm.ctpop.*
‘ Intrinsic¶
Syntax:¶
This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use llvm.ctpop on any integer bit width, or on any vector with integer elements. Not all targets support all bit widths or vector types, however.
declare i8 @llvm.ctpop.i8(i8 <src>)
declare i16 @llvm.ctpop.i16(i16 <src>)
declare i32 @llvm.ctpop.i32(i32 <src>)
declare i64 @llvm.ctpop.i64(i64 <src>)
declare i256 @llvm.ctpop.i256(i256 <src>)
declare <2 x i32> @llvm.ctpop.v2i32(<2 x i32> <src>)
Arguments:¶
The only argument is the value to be counted. The argument may be of any integer type, or a vector with integer elements. The return type must match the argument type.
Semantics:¶
The ‘llvm.ctpop
‘ intrinsic counts the 1’s in a variable, or within
each element of a vector.
‘llvm.ctlz.*
‘ Intrinsic¶
Syntax:¶
This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use llvm.ctlz
on any
integer bit width, or any vector whose elements are integers. Not all
targets support all bit widths or vector types, however.
declare i8 @llvm.ctlz.i8 (i8 <src>, i1 <is_zero_undef>)
declare i16 @llvm.ctlz.i16 (i16 <src>, i1 <is_zero_undef>)
declare i32 @llvm.ctlz.i32 (i32 <src>, i1 <is_zero_undef>)
declare i64 @llvm.ctlz.i64 (i64 <src>, i1 <is_zero_undef>)
declare i256 @llvm.ctlz.i256(i256 <src>, i1 <is_zero_undef>)
declare <2 x i32> @llvm.ctlz.v2i32(<2 x i32> <src>, i1 <is_zero_undef>)
Overview:¶
The ‘llvm.ctlz
‘ family of intrinsic functions counts the number of
leading zeros in a variable.
Arguments:¶
The first argument is the value to be counted. This argument may be of any integer type, or a vector with integer element type. The return type must match the first argument type.
The second argument must be a constant and is a flag to indicate whether the intrinsic should ensure that a zero as the first argument produces a defined result. Historically some architectures did not provide a defined result for zero values as efficiently, and many algorithms are now predicated on avoiding zero-value inputs.
Semantics:¶
The ‘llvm.ctlz
‘ intrinsic counts the leading (most significant)
zeros in a variable, or within each element of the vector. If
src == 0
then the result is the size in bits of the type of src
if is_zero_undef == 0
and undef
otherwise. For example,
llvm.ctlz(i32 2) = 30
.
‘llvm.cttz.*
‘ Intrinsic¶
Syntax:¶
This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use llvm.cttz
on any
integer bit width, or any vector of integer elements. Not all targets
support all bit widths or vector types, however.
declare i8 @llvm.cttz.i8 (i8 <src>, i1 <is_zero_undef>)
declare i16 @llvm.cttz.i16 (i16 <src>, i1 <is_zero_undef>)
declare i32 @llvm.cttz.i32 (i32 <src>, i1 <is_zero_undef>)
declare i64 @llvm.cttz.i64 (i64 <src>, i1 <is_zero_undef>)
declare i256 @llvm.cttz.i256(i256 <src>, i1 <is_zero_undef>)
declare <2 x i32> @llvm.cttz.v2i32(<2 x i32> <src>, i1 <is_zero_undef>)
Arguments:¶
The first argument is the value to be counted. This argument may be of any integer type, or a vector with integer element type. The return type must match the first argument type.
The second argument must be a constant and is a flag to indicate whether the intrinsic should ensure that a zero as the first argument produces a defined result. Historically some architectures did not provide a defined result for zero values as efficiently, and many algorithms are now predicated on avoiding zero-value inputs.
Semantics:¶
The ‘llvm.cttz
‘ intrinsic counts the trailing (least significant)
zeros in a variable, or within each element of a vector. If src == 0
then the result is the size in bits of the type of src
if
is_zero_undef == 0
and undef
otherwise. For example,
llvm.cttz(2) = 1
.
Arithmetic with Overflow Intrinsics¶
LLVM provides intrinsics for some arithmetic with overflow operations.
‘llvm.sadd.with.overflow.*
‘ Intrinsics¶
Syntax:¶
This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use llvm.sadd.with.overflow
on any integer bit width.
declare {i16, i1} @llvm.sadd.with.overflow.i16(i16 %a, i16 %b)
declare {i32, i1} @llvm.sadd.with.overflow.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b)
declare {i64, i1} @llvm.sadd.with.overflow.i64(i64 %a, i64 %b)
Overview:¶
The ‘llvm.sadd.with.overflow
‘ family of intrinsic functions perform
a signed addition of the two arguments, and indicate whether an overflow
occurred during the signed summation.
Arguments:¶
The arguments (%a and %b) and the first element of the result structure
may be of integer types of any bit width, but they must have the same
bit width. The second element of the result structure must be of type
i1
. %a
and %b
are the two values that will undergo signed
addition.
Semantics:¶
The ‘llvm.sadd.with.overflow
‘ family of intrinsic functions perform
a signed addition of the two variables. They return a structure — the
first element of which is the signed summation, and the second element
of which is a bit specifying if the signed summation resulted in an
overflow.
‘llvm.uadd.with.overflow.*
‘ Intrinsics¶
Syntax:¶
This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use llvm.uadd.with.overflow
on any integer bit width.
declare {i16, i1} @llvm.uadd.with.overflow.i16(i16 %a, i16 %b)
declare {i32, i1} @llvm.uadd.with.overflow.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b)
declare {i64, i1} @llvm.uadd.with.overflow.i64(i64 %a, i64 %b)
Overview:¶
The ‘llvm.uadd.with.overflow
‘ family of intrinsic functions perform
an unsigned addition of the two arguments, and indicate whether a carry
occurred during the unsigned summation.
Arguments:¶
The arguments (%a and %b) and the first element of the result structure
may be of integer types of any bit width, but they must have the same
bit width. The second element of the result structure must be of type
i1
. %a
and %b
are the two values that will undergo unsigned
addition.
Semantics:¶
The ‘llvm.uadd.with.overflow
‘ family of intrinsic functions perform
an unsigned addition of the two arguments. They return a structure — the
first element of which is the sum, and the second element of which is a
bit specifying if the unsigned summation resulted in a carry.
‘llvm.ssub.with.overflow.*
‘ Intrinsics¶
Syntax:¶
This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use llvm.ssub.with.overflow
on any integer bit width.
declare {i16, i1} @llvm.ssub.with.overflow.i16(i16 %a, i16 %b)
declare {i32, i1} @llvm.ssub.with.overflow.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b)
declare {i64, i1} @llvm.ssub.with.overflow.i64(i64 %a, i64 %b)
Overview:¶
The ‘llvm.ssub.with.overflow
‘ family of intrinsic functions perform
a signed subtraction of the two arguments, and indicate whether an
overflow occurred during the signed subtraction.
Arguments:¶
The arguments (%a and %b) and the first element of the result structure
may be of integer types of any bit width, but they must have the same
bit width. The second element of the result structure must be of type
i1
. %a
and %b
are the two values that will undergo signed
subtraction.
Semantics:¶
The ‘llvm.ssub.with.overflow
‘ family of intrinsic functions perform
a signed subtraction of the two arguments. They return a structure — the
first element of which is the subtraction, and the second element of
which is a bit specifying if the signed subtraction resulted in an
overflow.
‘llvm.usub.with.overflow.*
‘ Intrinsics¶
Syntax:¶
This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use llvm.usub.with.overflow
on any integer bit width.
declare {i16, i1} @llvm.usub.with.overflow.i16(i16 %a, i16 %b)
declare {i32, i1} @llvm.usub.with.overflow.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b)
declare {i64, i1} @llvm.usub.with.overflow.i64(i64 %a, i64 %b)
Overview:¶
The ‘llvm.usub.with.overflow
‘ family of intrinsic functions perform
an unsigned subtraction of the two arguments, and indicate whether an
overflow occurred during the unsigned subtraction.
Arguments:¶
The arguments (%a and %b) and the first element of the result structure
may be of integer types of any bit width, but they must have the same
bit width. The second element of the result structure must be of type
i1
. %a
and %b
are the two values that will undergo unsigned
subtraction.
Semantics:¶
The ‘llvm.usub.with.overflow
‘ family of intrinsic functions perform
an unsigned subtraction of the two arguments. They return a structure —
the first element of which is the subtraction, and the second element of
which is a bit specifying if the unsigned subtraction resulted in an
overflow.
‘llvm.smul.with.overflow.*
‘ Intrinsics¶
Syntax:¶
This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use llvm.smul.with.overflow
on any integer bit width.
declare {i16, i1} @llvm.smul.with.overflow.i16(i16 %a, i16 %b)
declare {i32, i1} @llvm.smul.with.overflow.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b)
declare {i64, i1} @llvm.smul.with.overflow.i64(i64 %a, i64 %b)
Overview:¶
The ‘llvm.smul.with.overflow
‘ family of intrinsic functions perform
a signed multiplication of the two arguments, and indicate whether an
overflow occurred during the signed multiplication.
Arguments:¶
The arguments (%a and %b) and the first element of the result structure
may be of integer types of any bit width, but they must have the same
bit width. The second element of the result structure must be of type
i1
. %a
and %b
are the two values that will undergo signed
multiplication.
Semantics:¶
The ‘llvm.smul.with.overflow
‘ family of intrinsic functions perform
a signed multiplication of the two arguments. They return a structure —
the first element of which is the multiplication, and the second element
of which is a bit specifying if the signed multiplication resulted in an
overflow.
‘llvm.umul.with.overflow.*
‘ Intrinsics¶
Syntax:¶
This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use llvm.umul.with.overflow
on any integer bit width.
declare {i16, i1} @llvm.umul.with.overflow.i16(i16 %a, i16 %b)
declare {i32, i1} @llvm.umul.with.overflow.i32(i32 %a, i32 %b)
declare {i64, i1} @llvm.umul.with.overflow.i64(i64 %a, i64 %b)
Overview:¶
The ‘llvm.umul.with.overflow
‘ family of intrinsic functions perform
a unsigned multiplication of the two arguments, and indicate whether an
overflow occurred during the unsigned multiplication.
Arguments:¶
The arguments (%a and %b) and the first element of the result structure
may be of integer types of any bit width, but they must have the same
bit width. The second element of the result structure must be of type
i1
. %a
and %b
are the two values that will undergo unsigned
multiplication.
Semantics:¶
The ‘llvm.umul.with.overflow
‘ family of intrinsic functions perform
an unsigned multiplication of the two arguments. They return a structure —
the first element of which is the multiplication, and the second
element of which is a bit specifying if the unsigned multiplication
resulted in an overflow.
Specialised Arithmetic Intrinsics¶
‘llvm.canonicalize.*
‘ Intrinsic¶
Syntax:¶
declare float @llvm.canonicalize.f32(float %a)
declare double @llvm.canonicalize.f64(double %b)
Overview:¶
The ‘llvm.canonicalize.*
‘ intrinsic returns the platform specific canonical
encoding of a floating point number. This canonicalization is useful for
implementing certain numeric primitives such as frexp. The canonical encoding is
defined by IEEE-754-2008 to be:
2.1.8 canonical encoding: The preferred encoding of a floating-point
representation in a format. Applied to declets, significands of finite
numbers, infinities, and NaNs, especially in decimal formats.
This operation can also be considered equivalent to the IEEE-754-2008 conversion of a floating-point value to the same format. NaNs are handled according to section 6.2.
Examples of non-canonical encodings:
- x87 pseudo denormals, pseudo NaNs, pseudo Infinity, Unnormals. These are converted to a canonical representation per hardware-specific protocol.
- Many normal decimal floating point numbers have non-canonical alternative encodings.
- Some machines, like GPUs or ARMv7 NEON, do not support subnormal values. These are treated as non-canonical encodings of zero and will be flushed to a zero of the same sign by this operation.
Note that per IEEE-754-2008 6.2, systems that support signaling NaNs with default exception handling must signal an invalid exception, and produce a quiet NaN result.
This function should always be implementable as multiplication by 1.0, provided
that the compiler does not constant fold the operation. Likewise, division by
1.0 and llvm.minnum(x, x)
are possible implementations. Addition with
-0.0 is also sufficient provided that the rounding mode is not -Infinity.
@llvm.canonicalize
must preserve the equality relation. That is:
(@llvm.canonicalize(x) == x)
is equivalent to(x == x)
(@llvm.canonicalize(x) == @llvm.canonicalize(y))
is equivalent to to(x == y)
Additionally, the sign of zero must be conserved:
@llvm.canonicalize(-0.0) = -0.0
and @llvm.canonicalize(+0.0) = +0.0
The payload bits of a NaN must be conserved, with two exceptions. First, environments which use only a single canonical representation of NaN must perform said canonicalization. Second, SNaNs must be quieted per the usual methods.
The canonicalization operation may be optimized away if:
- The input is known to be canonical. For example, it was produced by a floating-point operation that is required by the standard to be canonical.
- The result is consumed only by (or fused with) other floating-point operations. That is, the bits of the floating point value are not examined.
‘llvm.fmuladd.*
‘ Intrinsic¶
Syntax:¶
declare float @llvm.fmuladd.f32(float %a, float %b, float %c)
declare double @llvm.fmuladd.f64(double %a, double %b, double %c)
Overview:¶
The ‘llvm.fmuladd.*
‘ intrinsic functions represent multiply-add
expressions that can be fused if the code generator determines that (a) the
target instruction set has support for a fused operation, and (b) that the
fused operation is more efficient than the equivalent, separate pair of mul
and add instructions.
Arguments:¶
The ‘llvm.fmuladd.*
‘ intrinsics each take three arguments: two
multiplicands, a and b, and an addend c.
Semantics:¶
The expression:
%0 = call float @llvm.fmuladd.f32(%a, %b, %c)
is equivalent to the expression a * b + c, except that rounding will
not be performed between the multiplication and addition steps if the
code generator fuses the operations. Fusion is not guaranteed, even if
the target platform supports it. If a fused multiply-add is required the
corresponding llvm.fma.* intrinsic function should be used
instead. This never sets errno, just as ‘llvm.fma.*
‘.
Half Precision Floating Point Intrinsics¶
For most target platforms, half precision floating point is a storage-only format. This means that it is a dense encoding (in memory) but does not support computation in the format.
This means that code must first load the half-precision floating point value as an i16, then convert it to float with llvm.convert.from.fp16. Computation can then be performed on the float value (including extending to double etc). To store the value back to memory, it is first converted to float if needed, then converted to i16 with llvm.convert.to.fp16, then storing as an i16 value.
‘llvm.convert.to.fp16
‘ Intrinsic¶
Syntax:¶
declare i16 @llvm.convert.to.fp16.f32(float %a)
declare i16 @llvm.convert.to.fp16.f64(double %a)
Overview:¶
The ‘llvm.convert.to.fp16
‘ intrinsic function performs a conversion from a
conventional floating point type to half precision floating point format.
Arguments:¶
The intrinsic function contains single argument - the value to be converted.
Semantics:¶
The ‘llvm.convert.to.fp16
‘ intrinsic function performs a conversion from a
conventional floating point format to half precision floating point format. The
return value is an i16
which contains the converted number.
‘llvm.convert.from.fp16
‘ Intrinsic¶
Syntax:¶
declare float @llvm.convert.from.fp16.f32(i16 %a)
declare double @llvm.convert.from.fp16.f64(i16 %a)
Overview:¶
The ‘llvm.convert.from.fp16
‘ intrinsic function performs a
conversion from half precision floating point format to single precision
floating point format.
Arguments:¶
The intrinsic function contains single argument - the value to be converted.
Semantics:¶
The ‘llvm.convert.from.fp16
‘ intrinsic function performs a
conversion from half single precision floating point format to single
precision floating point format. The input half-float value is
represented by an i16
value.
Debugger Intrinsics¶
The LLVM debugger intrinsics (which all start with llvm.dbg.
prefix), are described in the LLVM Source Level
Debugging
document.
Exception Handling Intrinsics¶
The LLVM exception handling intrinsics (which all start with
llvm.eh.
prefix), are described in the LLVM Exception
Handling document.
Trampoline Intrinsics¶
These intrinsics make it possible to excise one parameter, marked with the nest attribute, from a function. The result is a callable function pointer lacking the nest parameter - the caller does not need to provide a value for it. Instead, the value to use is stored in advance in a “trampoline”, a block of memory usually allocated on the stack, which also contains code to splice the nest value into the argument list. This is used to implement the GCC nested function address extension.
For example, if the function is i32 f(i8* nest %c, i32 %x, i32 %y)
then the resulting function pointer has signature i32 (i32, i32)*
.
It can be created as follows:
%tramp = alloca [10 x i8], align 4 ; size and alignment only correct for X86
%tramp1 = getelementptr [10 x i8], [10 x i8]* %tramp, i32 0, i32 0
call i8* @llvm.init.trampoline(i8* %tramp1, i8* bitcast (i32 (i8*, i32, i32)* @f to i8*), i8* %nval)
%p = call i8* @llvm.adjust.trampoline(i8* %tramp1)
%fp = bitcast i8* %p to i32 (i32, i32)*
The call %val = call i32 %fp(i32 %x, i32 %y)
is then equivalent to
%val = call i32 %f(i8* %nval, i32 %x, i32 %y)
.
‘llvm.init.trampoline
‘ Intrinsic¶
Overview:¶
This fills the memory pointed to by tramp
with executable code,
turning it into a trampoline.
Arguments:¶
The llvm.init.trampoline
intrinsic takes three arguments, all
pointers. The tramp
argument must point to a sufficiently large and
sufficiently aligned block of memory; this memory is written to by the
intrinsic. Note that the size and the alignment are target-specific -
LLVM currently provides no portable way of determining them, so a
front-end that generates this intrinsic needs to have some
target-specific knowledge. The func
argument must hold a function
bitcast to an i8*
.
Semantics:¶
The block of memory pointed to by tramp
is filled with target
dependent code, turning it into a function. Then tramp
needs to be
passed to llvm.adjust.trampoline to get a pointer which can
be bitcast (to a new function) and called. The new
function’s signature is the same as that of func
with any arguments
marked with the nest
attribute removed. At most one such nest
argument is allowed, and it must be of pointer type. Calling the new
function is equivalent to calling func
with the same argument list,
but with nval
used for the missing nest
argument. If, after
calling llvm.init.trampoline
, the memory pointed to by tramp
is
modified, then the effect of any later call to the returned function
pointer is undefined.
‘llvm.adjust.trampoline
‘ Intrinsic¶
Overview:¶
This performs any required machine-specific adjustment to the address of
a trampoline (passed as tramp
).
Arguments:¶
tramp
must point to a block of memory which already has trampoline
code filled in by a previous call to
llvm.init.trampoline.
Semantics:¶
On some architectures the address of the code to be executed needs to be
different than the address where the trampoline is actually stored. This
intrinsic returns the executable address corresponding to tramp
after performing the required machine specific adjustments. The pointer
returned can then be bitcast and executed.
Masked Vector Load and Store Intrinsics¶
LLVM provides intrinsics for predicated vector load and store operations. The predicate is specified by a mask operand, which holds one bit per vector element, switching the associated vector lane on or off. The memory addresses corresponding to the “off” lanes are not accessed. When all bits of the mask are on, the intrinsic is identical to a regular vector load or store. When all bits are off, no memory is accessed.
‘llvm.masked.load.*
‘ Intrinsics¶
Syntax:¶
This is an overloaded intrinsic. The loaded data is a vector of any integer, floating point or pointer data type.
declare <16 x float> @llvm.masked.load.v16f32 (<16 x float>* <ptr>, i32 <alignment>, <16 x i1> <mask>, <16 x float> <passthru>)
declare <2 x double> @llvm.masked.load.v2f64 (<2 x double>* <ptr>, i32 <alignment>, <2 x i1> <mask>, <2 x double> <passthru>)
;; The data is a vector of pointers to double
declare <8 x double*> @llvm.masked.load.v8p0f64 (<8 x double*>* <ptr>, i32 <alignment>, <8 x i1> <mask>, <8 x double*> <passthru>)
;; The data is a vector of function pointers
declare <8 x i32 ()*> @llvm.masked.load.v8p0f_i32f (<8 x i32 ()*>* <ptr>, i32 <alignment>, <8 x i1> <mask>, <8 x i32 ()*> <passthru>)
Overview:¶
Reads a vector from memory according to the provided mask. The mask holds a bit for each vector lane, and is used to prevent memory accesses to the masked-off lanes. The masked-off lanes in the result vector are taken from the corresponding lanes of the ‘passthru
‘ operand.
Arguments:¶
The first operand is the base pointer for the load. The second operand is the alignment of the source location. It must be a constant integer value. The third operand, mask, is a vector of boolean values with the same number of elements as the return type. The fourth is a pass-through value that is used to fill the masked-off lanes of the result. The return type, underlying type of the base pointer and the type of the ‘passthru
‘ operand are the same vector types.
Semantics:¶
The ‘llvm.masked.load
‘ intrinsic is designed for conditional reading of selected vector elements in a single IR operation. It is useful for targets that support vector masked loads and allows vectorizing predicated basic blocks on these targets. Other targets may support this intrinsic differently, for example by lowering it into a sequence of branches that guard scalar load operations.
The result of this operation is equivalent to a regular vector load instruction followed by a ‘select’ between the loaded and the passthru values, predicated on the same mask. However, using this intrinsic prevents exceptions on memory access to masked-off lanes.
%res = call <16 x float> @llvm.masked.load.v16f32 (<16 x float>* %ptr, i32 4, <16 x i1>%mask, <16 x float> %passthru)
;; The result of the two following instructions is identical aside from potential memory access exception
%loadlal = load <16 x float>, <16 x float>* %ptr, align 4
%res = select <16 x i1> %mask, <16 x float> %loadlal, <16 x float> %passthru
‘llvm.masked.store.*
‘ Intrinsics¶
Syntax:¶
This is an overloaded intrinsic. The data stored in memory is a vector of any integer, floating point or pointer data type.
declare void @llvm.masked.store.v8i32 (<8 x i32> <value>, <8 x i32>* <ptr>, i32 <alignment>, <8 x i1> <mask>)
declare void @llvm.masked.store.v16f32 (<16 x float> <value>, <16 x float>* <ptr>, i32 <alignment>, <16 x i1> <mask>)
;; The data is a vector of pointers to double
declare void @llvm.masked.store.v8p0f64 (<8 x double*> <value>, <8 x double*>* <ptr>, i32 <alignment>, <8 x i1> <mask>)
;; The data is a vector of function pointers
declare void @llvm.masked.store.v4p0f_i32f (<4 x i32 ()*> <value>, <4 x i32 ()*>* <ptr>, i32 <alignment>, <4 x i1> <mask>)
Overview:¶
Writes a vector to memory according to the provided mask. The mask holds a bit for each vector lane, and is used to prevent memory accesses to the masked-off lanes.
Arguments:¶
The first operand is the vector value to be written to memory. The second operand is the base pointer for the store, it has the same underlying type as the value operand. The third operand is the alignment of the destination location. The fourth operand, mask, is a vector of boolean values. The types of the mask and the value operand must have the same number of vector elements.
Semantics:¶
The ‘llvm.masked.store
‘ intrinsics is designed for conditional writing of selected vector elements in a single IR operation. It is useful for targets that support vector masked store and allows vectorizing predicated basic blocks on these targets. Other targets may support this intrinsic differently, for example by lowering it into a sequence of branches that guard scalar store operations.
The result of this operation is equivalent to a load-modify-store sequence. However, using this intrinsic prevents exceptions and data races on memory access to masked-off lanes.
call void @llvm.masked.store.v16f32(<16 x float> %value, <16 x float>* %ptr, i32 4, <16 x i1> %mask)
;; The result of the following instructions is identical aside from potential data races and memory access exceptions
%oldval = load <16 x float>, <16 x float>* %ptr, align 4
%res = select <16 x i1> %mask, <16 x float> %value, <16 x float> %oldval
store <16 x float> %res, <16 x float>* %ptr, align 4
Masked Vector Gather and Scatter Intrinsics¶
LLVM provides intrinsics for vector gather and scatter operations. They are similar to Masked Vector Load and Store, except they are designed for arbitrary memory accesses, rather than sequential memory accesses. Gather and scatter also employ a mask operand, which holds one bit per vector element, switching the associated vector lane on or off. The memory addresses corresponding to the “off” lanes are not accessed. When all bits are off, no memory is accessed.
‘llvm.masked.gather.*
‘ Intrinsics¶
Syntax:¶
This is an overloaded intrinsic. The loaded data are multiple scalar values of any integer, floating point or pointer data type gathered together into one vector.
declare <16 x float> @llvm.masked.gather.v16f32 (<16 x float*> <ptrs>, i32 <alignment>, <16 x i1> <mask>, <16 x float> <passthru>)
declare <2 x double> @llvm.masked.gather.v2f64 (<2 x double*> <ptrs>, i32 <alignment>, <2 x i1> <mask>, <2 x double> <passthru>)
declare <8 x float*> @llvm.masked.gather.v8p0f32 (<8 x float**> <ptrs>, i32 <alignment>, <8 x i1> <mask>, <8 x float*> <passthru>)
Overview:¶
Reads scalar values from arbitrary memory locations and gathers them into one vector. The memory locations are provided in the vector of pointers ‘ptrs
‘. The memory is accessed according to the provided mask. The mask holds a bit for each vector lane, and is used to prevent memory accesses to the masked-off lanes. The masked-off lanes in the result vector are taken from the corresponding lanes of the ‘passthru
‘ operand.
Arguments:¶
The first operand is a vector of pointers which holds all memory addresses to read. The second operand is an alignment of the source addresses. It must be a constant integer value. The third operand, mask, is a vector of boolean values with the same number of elements as the return type. The fourth is a pass-through value that is used to fill the masked-off lanes of the result. The return type, underlying type of the vector of pointers and the type of the ‘passthru
‘ operand are the same vector types.
Semantics:¶
The ‘llvm.masked.gather
‘ intrinsic is designed for conditional reading of multiple scalar values from arbitrary memory locations in a single IR operation. It is useful for targets that support vector masked gathers and allows vectorizing basic blocks with data and control divergence. Other targets may support this intrinsic differently, for example by lowering it into a sequence of scalar load operations.
The semantics of this operation are equivalent to a sequence of conditional scalar loads with subsequent gathering all loaded values into a single vector. The mask restricts memory access to certain lanes and facilitates vectorization of predicated basic blocks.
%res = call <4 x double> @llvm.masked.gather.v4f64 (<4 x double*> %ptrs, i32 8, <4 x i1>%mask, <4 x double> <true, true, true, true>)
;; The gather with all-true mask is equivalent to the following instruction sequence
%ptr0 = extractelement <4 x double*> %ptrs, i32 0
%ptr1 = extractelement <4 x double*> %ptrs, i32 1
%ptr2 = extractelement <4 x double*> %ptrs, i32 2
%ptr3 = extractelement <4 x double*> %ptrs, i32 3
%val0 = load double, double* %ptr0, align 8
%val1 = load double, double* %ptr1, align 8
%val2 = load double, double* %ptr2, align 8
%val3 = load double, double* %ptr3, align 8
%vec0 = insertelement <4 x double>undef, %val0, 0
%vec01 = insertelement <4 x double>%vec0, %val1, 1
%vec012 = insertelement <4 x double>%vec01, %val2, 2
%vec0123 = insertelement <4 x double>%vec012, %val3, 3
‘llvm.masked.scatter.*
‘ Intrinsics¶
Syntax:¶
This is an overloaded intrinsic. The data stored in memory is a vector of any integer, floating point or pointer data type. Each vector element is stored in an arbitrary memory address. Scatter with overlapping addresses is guaranteed to be ordered from least-significant to most-significant element.
declare void @llvm.masked.scatter.v8i32 (<8 x i32> <value>, <8 x i32*> <ptrs>, i32 <alignment>, <8 x i1> <mask>)
declare void @llvm.masked.scatter.v16f32 (<16 x float> <value>, <16 x float*> <ptrs>, i32 <alignment>, <16 x i1> <mask>)
declare void @llvm.masked.scatter.v4p0f64 (<4 x double*> <value>, <4 x double**> <ptrs>, i32 <alignment>, <4 x i1> <mask>)
Overview:¶
Writes each element from the value vector to the corresponding memory address. The memory addresses are represented as a vector of pointers. Writing is done according to the provided mask. The mask holds a bit for each vector lane, and is used to prevent memory accesses to the masked-off lanes.
Arguments:¶
The first operand is a vector value to be written to memory. The second operand is a vector of pointers, pointing to where the value elements should be stored. It has the same underlying type as the value operand. The third operand is an alignment of the destination addresses. The fourth operand, mask, is a vector of boolean values. The types of the mask and the value operand must have the same number of vector elements.
Semantics:¶
The ‘llvm.masked.scatter
‘ intrinsics is designed for writing selected vector elements to arbitrary memory addresses in a single IR operation. The operation may be conditional, when not all bits in the mask are switched on. It is useful for targets that support vector masked scatter and allows vectorizing basic blocks with data and control divergence. Other targets may support this intrinsic differently, for example by lowering it into a sequence of branches that guard scalar store operations.
;; This instruction unconditionally stores data vector in multiple addresses
call @llvm.masked.scatter.v8i32 (<8 x i32> %value, <8 x i32*> %ptrs, i32 4, <8 x i1> <true, true, .. true>)
;; It is equivalent to a list of scalar stores
%val0 = extractelement <8 x i32> %value, i32 0
%val1 = extractelement <8 x i32> %value, i32 1
..
%val7 = extractelement <8 x i32> %value, i32 7
%ptr0 = extractelement <8 x i32*> %ptrs, i32 0
%ptr1 = extractelement <8 x i32*> %ptrs, i32 1
..
%ptr7 = extractelement <8 x i32*> %ptrs, i32 7
;; Note: the order of the following stores is important when they overlap:
store i32 %val0, i32* %ptr0, align 4
store i32 %val1, i32* %ptr1, align 4
..
store i32 %val7, i32* %ptr7, align 4
Memory Use Markers¶
This class of intrinsics provides information about the lifetime of memory objects and ranges where variables are immutable.
‘llvm.lifetime.start
‘ Intrinsic¶
Arguments:¶
The first argument is a constant integer representing the size of the object, or -1 if it is variable sized. The second argument is a pointer to the object.
Semantics:¶
This intrinsic indicates that before this point in the code, the value
of the memory pointed to by ptr
is dead. This means that it is known
to never be used and has an undefined value. A load from the pointer
that precedes this intrinsic can be replaced with 'undef'
.
‘llvm.lifetime.end
‘ Intrinsic¶
Arguments:¶
The first argument is a constant integer representing the size of the object, or -1 if it is variable sized. The second argument is a pointer to the object.
Semantics:¶
This intrinsic indicates that after this point in the code, the value of
the memory pointed to by ptr
is dead. This means that it is known to
never be used and has an undefined value. Any stores into the memory
object following this intrinsic may be removed as dead.
‘llvm.invariant.start
‘ Intrinsic¶
Overview:¶
The ‘llvm.invariant.start
‘ intrinsic specifies that the contents of
a memory object will not change.
Arguments:¶
The first argument is a constant integer representing the size of the object, or -1 if it is variable sized. The second argument is a pointer to the object.
Semantics:¶
This intrinsic indicates that until an llvm.invariant.end
that uses
the return value, the referenced memory location is constant and
unchanging.
‘llvm.invariant.end
‘ Intrinsic¶
Overview:¶
The ‘llvm.invariant.end
‘ intrinsic specifies that the contents of a
memory object are mutable.
Arguments:¶
The first argument is the matching llvm.invariant.start
intrinsic.
The second argument is a constant integer representing the size of the
object, or -1 if it is variable sized and the third argument is a
pointer to the object.
Semantics:¶
This intrinsic indicates that the memory is mutable again.
‘llvm.invariant.group.barrier
‘ Intrinsic¶
Overview:¶
The ‘llvm.invariant.group.barrier
‘ intrinsic can be used when an invariant
established by invariant.group metadata no longer holds, to obtain a new pointer
value that does not carry the invariant information.
Arguments:¶
The llvm.invariant.group.barrier
takes only one argument, which is
the pointer to the memory for which the invariant.group
no longer holds.
Semantics:¶
Returns another pointer that aliases its argument but which is considered different
for the purposes of load
/store
invariant.group
metadata.
General Intrinsics¶
This class of intrinsics is designed to be generic and has no specific purpose.
‘llvm.var.annotation
‘ Intrinsic¶
Arguments:¶
The first argument is a pointer to a value, the second is a pointer to a global string, the third is a pointer to a global string which is the source file name, and the last argument is the line number.
Semantics:¶
This intrinsic allows annotation of local variables with arbitrary strings. This can be useful for special purpose optimizations that want to look for these annotations. These have no other defined use; they are ignored by code generation and optimization.
‘llvm.ptr.annotation.*
‘ Intrinsic¶
Syntax:¶
This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ‘llvm.ptr.annotation
‘ on a
pointer to an integer of any width. NOTE you must specify an address space for
the pointer. The identifier for the default address space is the integer
‘0
‘.
declare i8* @llvm.ptr.annotation.p<address space>i8(i8* <val>, i8* <str>, i8* <str>, i32 <int>)
declare i16* @llvm.ptr.annotation.p<address space>i16(i16* <val>, i8* <str>, i8* <str>, i32 <int>)
declare i32* @llvm.ptr.annotation.p<address space>i32(i32* <val>, i8* <str>, i8* <str>, i32 <int>)
declare i64* @llvm.ptr.annotation.p<address space>i64(i64* <val>, i8* <str>, i8* <str>, i32 <int>)
declare i256* @llvm.ptr.annotation.p<address space>i256(i256* <val>, i8* <str>, i8* <str>, i32 <int>)
Arguments:¶
The first argument is a pointer to an integer value of arbitrary bitwidth (result of some expression), the second is a pointer to a global string, the third is a pointer to a global string which is the source file name, and the last argument is the line number. It returns the value of the first argument.
Semantics:¶
This intrinsic allows annotation of a pointer to an integer with arbitrary strings. This can be useful for special purpose optimizations that want to look for these annotations. These have no other defined use; they are ignored by code generation and optimization.
‘llvm.annotation.*
‘ Intrinsic¶
Syntax:¶
This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use ‘llvm.annotation
‘ on
any integer bit width.
declare i8 @llvm.annotation.i8(i8 <val>, i8* <str>, i8* <str>, i32 <int>)
declare i16 @llvm.annotation.i16(i16 <val>, i8* <str>, i8* <str>, i32 <int>)
declare i32 @llvm.annotation.i32(i32 <val>, i8* <str>, i8* <str>, i32 <int>)
declare i64 @llvm.annotation.i64(i64 <val>, i8* <str>, i8* <str>, i32 <int>)
declare i256 @llvm.annotation.i256(i256 <val>, i8* <str>, i8* <str>, i32 <int>)
Arguments:¶
The first argument is an integer value (result of some expression), the second is a pointer to a global string, the third is a pointer to a global string which is the source file name, and the last argument is the line number. It returns the value of the first argument.
Semantics:¶
This intrinsic allows annotations to be put on arbitrary expressions with arbitrary strings. This can be useful for special purpose optimizations that want to look for these annotations. These have no other defined use; they are ignored by code generation and optimization.
‘llvm.trap
‘ Intrinsic¶
Arguments:¶
None.
Semantics:¶
This intrinsic is lowered to the target dependent trap instruction. If
the target does not have a trap instruction, this intrinsic will be
lowered to a call of the abort()
function.
‘llvm.debugtrap
‘ Intrinsic¶
Arguments:¶
None.
Semantics:¶
This intrinsic is lowered to code which is intended to cause an execution trap with the intention of requesting the attention of a debugger.
‘llvm.stackprotector
‘ Intrinsic¶
Overview:¶
The llvm.stackprotector
intrinsic takes the guard
and stores it
onto the stack at slot
. The stack slot is adjusted to ensure that it
is placed on the stack before local variables.
Arguments:¶
The llvm.stackprotector
intrinsic requires two pointer arguments.
The first argument is the value loaded from the stack guard
@__stack_chk_guard
. The second variable is an alloca
that has
enough space to hold the value of the guard.
Semantics:¶
This intrinsic causes the prologue/epilogue inserter to force the position of
the AllocaInst
stack slot to be before local variables on the stack. This is
to ensure that if a local variable on the stack is overwritten, it will destroy
the value of the guard. When the function exits, the guard on the stack is
checked against the original guard by llvm.stackprotectorcheck
. If they are
different, then llvm.stackprotectorcheck
causes the program to abort by
calling the __stack_chk_fail()
function.
‘llvm.stackprotectorcheck
‘ Intrinsic¶
Overview:¶
The llvm.stackprotectorcheck
intrinsic compares guard
against an already
created stack protector and if they are not equal calls the
__stack_chk_fail()
function.
Arguments:¶
The llvm.stackprotectorcheck
intrinsic requires one pointer argument, the
the variable @__stack_chk_guard
.
Semantics:¶
This intrinsic is provided to perform the stack protector check by comparing
guard
with the stack slot created by llvm.stackprotector
and if the
values do not match call the __stack_chk_fail()
function.
The reason to provide this as an IR level intrinsic instead of implementing it via other IR operations is that in order to perform this operation at the IR level without an intrinsic, one would need to create additional basic blocks to handle the success/failure cases. This makes it difficult to stop the stack protector check from disrupting sibling tail calls in Codegen. With this intrinsic, we are able to generate the stack protector basic blocks late in codegen after the tail call decision has occurred.
‘llvm.objectsize
‘ Intrinsic¶
Syntax:¶
declare i32 @llvm.objectsize.i32(i8* <object>, i1 <min>)
declare i64 @llvm.objectsize.i64(i8* <object>, i1 <min>)
Overview:¶
The llvm.objectsize
intrinsic is designed to provide information to
the optimizers to determine at compile time whether a) an operation
(like memcpy) will overflow a buffer that corresponds to an object, or
b) that a runtime check for overflow isn’t necessary. An object in this
context means an allocation of a specific class, structure, array, or
other object.
Arguments:¶
The llvm.objectsize
intrinsic takes two arguments. The first
argument is a pointer to or into the object
. The second argument is
a boolean and determines whether llvm.objectsize
returns 0 (if true)
or -1 (if false) when the object size is unknown. The second argument
only accepts constants.
Semantics:¶
The llvm.objectsize
intrinsic is lowered to a constant representing
the size of the object concerned. If the size cannot be determined at
compile time, llvm.objectsize
returns i32/i64 -1 or 0
(depending
on the min
argument).
‘llvm.expect
‘ Intrinsic¶
Syntax:¶
This is an overloaded intrinsic. You can use llvm.expect
on any
integer bit width.
declare i1 @llvm.expect.i1(i1 <val>, i1 <expected_val>)
declare i32 @llvm.expect.i32(i32 <val>, i32 <expected_val>)
declare i64 @llvm.expect.i64(i64 <val>, i64 <expected_val>)
Overview:¶
The llvm.expect
intrinsic provides information about expected (the
most probable) value of val
, which can be used by optimizers.
Arguments:¶
The llvm.expect
intrinsic takes two arguments. The first argument is
a value. The second argument is an expected value, this needs to be a
constant value, variables are not allowed.
Semantics:¶
This intrinsic is lowered to the val
.
‘llvm.assume
‘ Intrinsic¶
Overview:¶
The llvm.assume
allows the optimizer to assume that the provided
condition is true. This information can then be used in simplifying other parts
of the code.
Arguments:¶
The condition which the optimizer may assume is always true.
Semantics:¶
The intrinsic allows the optimizer to assume that the provided condition is always true whenever the control flow reaches the intrinsic call. No code is generated for this intrinsic, and instructions that contribute only to the provided condition are not used for code generation. If the condition is violated during execution, the behavior is undefined.
Note that the optimizer might limit the transformations performed on values
used by the llvm.assume
intrinsic in order to preserve the instructions
only used to form the intrinsic’s input argument. This might prove undesirable
if the extra information provided by the llvm.assume
intrinsic does not cause
sufficient overall improvement in code quality. For this reason,
llvm.assume
should not be used to document basic mathematical invariants
that the optimizer can otherwise deduce or facts that are of little use to the
optimizer.
‘llvm.bitset.test
‘ Intrinsic¶
Arguments:¶
The first argument is a pointer to be tested. The second argument is a metadata object representing an identifier for a bitset.
‘llvm.donothing
‘ Intrinsic¶
Overview:¶
The llvm.donothing
intrinsic doesn’t perform any operation. It’s one of only
three intrinsics (besides llvm.experimental.patchpoint
and
llvm.experimental.gc.statepoint
) that can be called with an invoke
instruction.
Arguments:¶
None.
Semantics:¶
This intrinsic does nothing, and it’s removed by optimizers and ignored by codegen.
‘llvm.experimental.deoptimize
‘ Intrinsic¶
Overview:¶
This intrinsic, together with deoptimization operand bundles, allow frontends to express transfer of control and frame-local state from the currently executing (typically more specialized, hence faster) version of a function into another (typically more generic, hence slower) version.
In languages with a fully integrated managed runtime like Java and JavaScript this intrinsic can be used to implement “uncommon trap” or “side exit” like functionality. In unmanaged languages like C and C++, this intrinsic can be used to represent the slow paths of specialized functions.
Arguments:¶
The intrinsic takes an arbitrary number of arguments, whose meaning is decided by the lowering strategy.
Semantics:¶
The @llvm.experimental.deoptimize
intrinsic executes an attached
deoptimization continuation (denoted using a deoptimization
operand bundle) and returns the value returned by
the deoptimization continuation. Defining the semantic properties of
the continuation itself is out of scope of the language reference –
as far as LLVM is concerned, the deoptimization continuation can
invoke arbitrary side effects, including reading from and writing to
the entire heap.
Deoptimization continuations expressed using "deopt"
operand bundles always
continue execution to the end of the physical frame containing them, so all
calls to @llvm.experimental.deoptimize
must be in “tail position”:
@llvm.experimental.deoptimize
cannot be invoked.- The call must immediately precede a ret instruction.
- The
ret
instruction must return the value produced by the@llvm.experimental.deoptimize
call if there is one, or void.
Note that the above restrictions imply that the return type for a call to
@llvm.experimental.deoptimize
will match the return type of its immediate
caller.
The inliner composes the "deopt"
continuations of the caller into the
"deopt"
continuations present in the inlinee, and also updates calls to this
intrinsic to return directly from the frame of the function it inlined into.
Lowering:¶
Calls to @llvm.experimental.deoptimize
are lowered to calls to the
symbol __llvm_deoptimize
(it is the frontend’s responsibility to
ensure that this symbol is defined). The call arguments to
@llvm.experimental.deoptimize
are lowered as if they were formal
arguments of the specified types, and not as varargs.
‘llvm.experimental.guard
‘ Intrinsic¶
Overview:¶
This intrinsic, together with deoptimization operand bundles, allows frontends to express guards or checks on
optimistic assumptions made during compilation. The semantics of
@llvm.experimental.guard
is defined in terms of
@llvm.experimental.deoptimize
– its body is defined to be
equivalent to:
define void @llvm.experimental.guard(i1 %pred, <args...>) {
%realPred = and i1 %pred, undef
br i1 %realPred, label %continue, label %leave
leave:
call void @llvm.experimental.deoptimize(<args...>) [ "deopt"() ]
ret void
continue:
ret void
}
In words, @llvm.experimental.guard
executes the attached
"deopt"
continuation if (but not only if) its first argument
is false
. Since the optimizer is allowed to replace the undef
with an arbitrary value, it can optimize guard to fail “spuriously”,
i.e. without the original condition being false (hence the “not only
if”); and this allows for “check widening” type optimizations.
@llvm.experimental.guard
cannot be invoked.
Stack Map Intrinsics¶
LLVM provides experimental intrinsics to support runtime patching mechanisms commonly desired in dynamic language JITs. These intrinsics are described in Stack maps and patch points in LLVM.